Communication protocols over internet protocol (ip) networks

ABSTRACT

A system and methods comprise a gateway that includes a processor coupled to a security system at a premises. A touchscreen at the premises is coupled to the gateway and presents user interfaces. The user interfaces include a security interface that provides control of functions of the security system and access to data collected by the security system, and a network interface that provides access to network devices. A camera is located at the premises and coupled to the gateway via a plurality of interfaces. A security server at a remote location is coupled to the gateway. The security server comprises a client interface through which remote client devices exchange data with the gateway and the security system

CROSS REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS

This application is a continuation of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 16/696,657, filed on Nov. 26, 2019, which is a continuation of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/202,505, filed on Mar. 10, 2014, now U.S. Pat. No. 10,523,689, which is a continuation in part of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/932,837, filed on Jul. 1, 2013, now U.S. Pat. No. 9,621,408, which is a continuation in part of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/925,181, filed on Jun. 24, 2013, now U.S. Pat. No. 10,339,791, each of which is incorporated by reference in their entirety.

U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/202,505 claims the benefit of U.S. Patent Application No. 61/782,345, filed Mar. 14, 2013, and

claims the benefit of U.S. Patent Application No. 61/802,077, filed Mar. 15, 2013, and

claims the benefit of U.S. Patent Application No. 61/777,061, filed Mar. 12, 2013, and

claims the benefit of U.S. Patent Application No. 61/778,853, filed Mar. 13, 2013, and

claims the benefit of U.S. Patent Application No. 61/779,028, filed Mar. 13, 2013, and

claims the benefit of U.S. Patent Application No. 61/779,753, filed Mar. 13, 2013, and

claims the benefit of U.S. Patent Application No. 61/780,092, filed Mar. 13, 2013, and

claims the benefit of U.S. Patent Application No. 61/780,290, filed Mar. 13, 2013, and

claims the benefit of U.S. Patent Application No. 61/780,435, filed Mar. 13, 2013, and

claims the benefit of U.S. Patent Application No. 61/780,538, filed Mar. 13, 2013, and

claims the benefit of U.S. Patent Application No. 61/780,637, filed Mar. 13, 2013, and

claims the benefit of U.S. Patent Application No. 61/781,401, filed Mar. 14, 2013, and

claims the benefit of U.S. Patent Application No. 61/781,713, filed Mar. 14, 2013, and

is a continuation in part application of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/718,851, filed Dec. 18, 2012, now U.S. Pat. No. 10,156,831, and

is a continuation in part application of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/019,568, filed Jan. 24, 2008, now U.S. Pat. No. 10,142,932, and

is a continuation in part application of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/531,757, filed Jun. 25, 2012, now abandoned, and

is a continuation in part application of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/335,279, filed Dec. 22, 2011, now U.S. Pat. No. 11,113,950, and

is a continuation in part application of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/539,537, filed Aug. 11, 2009, now U.S. Pat. No. 10,156,959, and

is a continuation in part application of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/750,470, filed Mar. 30, 2010, now U.S. Pat. No. 9,191,228, and

is a continuation in part application of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/104,932, filed May 10, 2011, now abandoned, each of which is hereby incorporated by reference in their entirety.

TECHNICAL FIELD

The embodiments described herein relate generally to a method and apparatus for improving the capabilities of security systems in home and business applications. More particularly, the embodiments described herein relate to a touchscreen device that integrates security system control and functionality with network content interactivity, management and presentation.

BACKGROUND

The field of home and small business security is dominated by technology suppliers who build comprehensive ‘closed’ security systems, where the individual components (sensors, security panels, keypads) operate solely within the confines of a single vendor solution. For example, a wireless motion sensor from vendor A cannot be used with a security panel from vendor B. Each vendor typically has developed sophisticated proprietary wireless technologies to enable the installation and management of wireless sensors, with little or no ability for the wireless devices to operate separate from the vendor's homogeneous system. Furthermore, these traditional systems are extremely limited in their ability to interface either to a local or wide area standards-based network (such as an IP network); most installed systems support only a low-bandwidth, intermittent connection utilizing phone lines or cellular (RF) backup systems. Wireless security technology from providers such as GE Security, Honeywell, and DSC/Tyco are well known in the art, and are examples of this proprietary approach to security systems for home and business.

Furthermore, with the proliferation of the internet, ethernet and WiFi local area networks (LANs) and advanced wide area networks (WANs) that offer high bandwidth, low latency connections (broadband), as well as more advanced wireless WAN data networks (e.g. GPRS or CDMA 1×RTT) there increasingly exists the networking capability to extend these traditional security systems to offer enhanced functionality. In addition, the proliferation of broadband access has driven a corresponding increase in home and small business networking technologies and devices. It is desirable to extend traditional security systems to encompass enhanced functionality such as the ability to control and manage security systems from the world wide web, cellular telephones, or advanced function internet-based devices. Other desired functionality includes an open systems approach to interface home security systems to home and small business networks.

Due to the proprietary approach described above, the traditional vendors are the only ones capable of taking advantage of these new network functions. To date, even though the vast majority of home and business customers have broadband network access in their premises, most security systems do not offer the advanced capabilities associated with high speed, low-latency LANs and WANs. This is primarily because the proprietary vendors have not been able to deliver such technology efficiently or effectively. Solution providers attempting to address this need are becoming known in the art, including three categories of vendors: traditional proprietary hardware providers such as Honeywell and GE Security; third party hard-wired module providers such as Alarm.com, NextAlarm, and uControl; and new proprietary systems providers such as InGrid.

A disadvantage of the prior art technologies of the traditional proprietary hardware providers arises due to the continued proprietary approach of these vendors. As they develop technology in this area it once again operates only with the hardware from that specific vendor, ignoring the need for a heterogeneous, cross-vendor solution. Yet another disadvantage of the prior art technologies of the traditional proprietary hardware providers arises due to the lack of experience and capability of these companies in creating open internet and web based solutions, and consumer friendly interfaces.

A disadvantage of the prior art technologies of the third party hard-wired module providers arises due to the installation and operational complexities and functional limitations associated with hardwiring a new component into existing security systems. Moreover, a disadvantage of the prior art technologies of the new proprietary systems providers arises due to the need to discard all prior technologies, and implement an entirely new form of security system to access the new functionalities associated with broadband and wireless data networks. There remains, therefore, a need for systems, devices, and methods that easily interface to and control the existing proprietary security technologies utilizing a variety of wireless technologies.

INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE

Each patent, patent application, and/or publication mentioned in this specification is herein incorporated by reference in its entirety to the same extent as if each individual patent, patent application, and/or publication was specifically and individually indicated to be incorporated by reference.

BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS

FIG. 1 is a block diagram of the integrated security system, under an embodiment.

FIG. 2 is a block diagram of components of the integrated security system, under an embodiment.

FIG. 3 is a block diagram of the gateway software or applications, under an embodiment.

FIG. 4 is a block diagram of the gateway components, under an embodiment.

FIG. 5 is a block diagram of IP device integration with a premise network, under an embodiment.

FIG. 6 is a block diagram of IP device integration with a premise network, under an alternative embodiment.

FIG. 7 is a block diagram of a touchscreen, under an embodiment.

FIG. 8 is an example screenshot of a networked security touchscreen, under an embodiment.

FIG. 9 is a block diagram of network or premise device integration with a premise network, under an embodiment.

FIG. 10 is a block diagram of network or premise device integration with a premise network, under an alternative embodiment.

FIG. 11 is a flow diagram for a method of forming a security network including integrated security system components, under an embodiment.

FIG. 12 is a flow diagram for a method of forming a security network including integrated security system components and network devices, under an embodiment.

FIG. 13 is a flow diagram for installation of an IP device into a private network environment, under an embodiment.

FIG. 14 is a block diagram showing communications among IP devices of the private network environment, under an embodiment.

FIG. 15 is a flow diagram of a method of integrating an external control and management application system with an existing security system, under an embodiment.

FIG. 16 is a block diagram of an integrated security system wirelessly interfacing to proprietary security systems, under an embodiment.

FIG. 17 is a flow diagram for wirelessly ‘learning’ the gateway into an existing security system and discovering extant sensors, under an embodiment.

FIG. 18 is a block diagram of a security system in which the legacy panel is replaced with a wireless security panel wirelessly coupled to a gateway, under an embodiment.

FIG. 19 is a block diagram of a security system in which the legacy panel is replaced with a wireless security panel wirelessly coupled to a gateway, and a touchscreen, under an alternative embodiment.

FIG. 20 is a block diagram of a security system in which the legacy panel is replaced with a wireless security panel connected to a gateway via an Ethernet coupling, under another alternative embodiment.

FIG. 21 is a flow diagram for automatic takeover of a security system, under an embodiment.

FIG. 22 is a flow diagram for automatic takeover of a security system, under an alternative embodiment.

FIG. 23 is a general flow diagram for IP video control, under an embodiment.

FIG. 24 is a block diagram showing camera tunneling, under an embodiment.

FIG. 25 is a flow diagram illustrating a deployment scenario where the Camera is deployed in conjunction with a Premise Gateway at the customer premise, under an embodiment.

FIG. 26 is a flow diagram illustrating a deployment scenario where the Camera is deployed without requiring a Premise Gateway at the customer premise, under an embodiment.

FIG. 27 is a flow diagram of the state transition for a sequence, under an embodiment.

FIG. 28 is a flow diagram of sample call flows, under an embodiment.

FIG. 29 is a flow diagram of the state transition for a sequence, under an embodiment.

FIG. 30 is a flow diagram illustrating steps involved in off-premise bootstrap procedures, under an embodiment.

DETAILED DESCRIPTION

An integrated security system is described that integrates broadband and mobile access and control with conventional security systems and premise devices to provide a tri-mode security network (broadband, cellular/GSM, POTS access) that enables users to remotely stay connected to their premises. The integrated security system, while delivering remote premise monitoring and control functionality to conventional monitored premise protection, complements existing premise protection equipment. The integrated security system integrates into the premise network and couples wirelessly with the conventional security panel, enabling broadband access to premise security systems. Automation devices (cameras, lamp modules, thermostats, etc.) can be added, enabling users to remotely see live video and/or pictures and control home devices via their personal web portal or webpage, mobile phone, and/or other remote client device. Users can also receive notifications via email or text message when happenings occur, or do not occur, in their home.

Although the detailed description herein contains many specifics for the purposes of illustration, anyone of ordinary skill in the art will appreciate that many variations and alterations to the following details are within the scope of the embodiments described herein. Thus, the following illustrative embodiments are set forth without any loss of generality to, and without imposing limitations upon, the claimed invention.

As described herein, computer networks suitable for use with the embodiments described herein include local area networks (LAN), wide area networks (WAN), Internet, or other connection services and network variations such as the world wide web, the public internet, a private internet, a private computer network, a public network, a mobile network, a cellular network, a value-added network, and the like. Computing devices coupled or connected to the network may be any microprocessor controlled device that permits access to the network, including terminal devices, such as personal computers, workstations, servers, mini computers, main-frame computers, laptop computers, mobile computers, palm top computers, hand held computers, mobile phones, TV set-top boxes, or combinations thereof. The computer network may include one of more LANs, WANs, Internets, and computers. The computers may serve as servers, clients, or a combination thereof.

The integrated security system can be a component of a single system, multiple systems, and/or geographically separate systems. The integrated security system can also be a subcomponent or subsystem of a single system, multiple systems, and/or geographically separate systems. The integrated security system can be coupled to one or more other components (not shown) of a host system or a system coupled to the host system.

One or more components of the integrated security system and/or a corresponding system or application to which the integrated security system is coupled or connected includes and/or runs under and/or in association with a processing system. The processing system includes any collection of processor-based devices or computing devices operating together, or components of processing systems or devices, as is known in the art. For example, the processing system can include one or more of a portable computer, portable communication device operating in a communication network, and/or a network server. The portable computer can be any of a number and/or combination of devices selected from among personal computers, personal digital assistants, portable computing devices, and portable communication devices, but is not so limited. The processing system can include components within a larger computer system.

The processing system of an embodiment includes at least one processor and at least one memory device or subsystem. The processing system can also include or be coupled to at least one database. The term “processor” as generally used herein refers to any logic processing unit, such as one or more central processing units (CPUs), digital signal processors (DSPs), application-specific integrated circuits (ASIC), etc. The processor and memory can be monolithically integrated onto a single chip, distributed among a number of chips or components, and/or provided by some combination of algorithms. The methods described herein can be implemented in one or more of software algorithm(s), programs, firmware, hardware, components, circuitry, in any combination.

The components of any system that includes the integrated security system can be located together or in separate locations. Communication paths couple the components and include any medium for communicating or transferring files among the components. The communication paths include wireless connections, wired connections, and hybrid wireless/wired connections. The communication paths also include couplings or connections to networks including local area networks (LANs), metropolitan area networks (MANs), wide area networks (WANs), proprietary networks, interoffice or backend networks, and the Internet. Furthermore, the communication paths include removable fixed mediums like floppy disks, hard disk drives, and CD-ROM disks, as well as flash RAM, Universal Serial Bus (USB) connections, RS-232 connections, telephone lines, buses, and electronic mail messages.

Aspects of the integrated security system and corresponding systems and methods described herein may be implemented as functionality programmed into any of a variety of circuitry, including programmable logic devices (PLDs), such as field programmable gate arrays (FPGAs), programmable array logic (PAL) devices, electrically programmable logic and memory devices and standard cell-based devices, as well as application specific integrated circuits (ASICs). Some other possibilities for implementing aspects of the integrated security system and corresponding systems and methods include: microcontrollers with memory (such as electronically erasable programmable read only memory (EEPROM)), embedded microprocessors, firmware, software, etc. Furthermore, aspects of the integrated security system and corresponding systems and methods may be embodied in microprocessors having software-based circuit emulation, discrete logic (sequential and combinatorial), custom devices, fuzzy (neural) logic, quantum devices, and hybrids of any of the above device types. Of course the underlying device technologies may be provided in a variety of component types, e.g., metal-oxide semiconductor field-effect transistor (MOSFET) technologies like complementary metal-oxide semiconductor (CMOS), bipolar technologies like emitter-coupled logic (ECL), polymer technologies (e.g., silicon-conjugated polymer and metal-conjugated polymer-metal structures), mixed analog and digital, etc.

It should be noted that any system, method, and/or other components disclosed herein may be described using computer aided design tools and expressed (or represented), as data and/or instructions embodied in various computer-readable media, in terms of their behavioral, register transfer, logic component, transistor, layout geometries, and/or other characteristics. Computer-readable media in which such formatted data and/or instructions may be embodied include, but are not limited to, non-volatile storage media in various forms (e.g., optical, magnetic or semiconductor storage media) and carrier waves that may be used to transfer such formatted data and/or instructions through wireless, optical, or wired signaling media or any combination thereof. Examples of transfers of such formatted data and/or instructions by carrier waves include, but are not limited to, transfers (uploads, downloads, e-mail, etc.) over the Internet and/or other computer networks via one or more data transfer protocols (e.g., HTTP, FTP, SMTP, etc.). When received within a computer system via one or more computer-readable media, such data and/or instruction-based expressions of the above described components may be processed by a processing entity (e.g., one or more processors) within the computer system in conjunction with execution of one or more other computer programs.

Unless the context clearly requires otherwise, throughout the description and the claims, the words “comprise,” “comprising,” and the like are to be construed in an inclusive sense as opposed to an exclusive or exhaustive sense; that is to say, in a sense of “including, but not limited to.” Words using the singular or plural number also include the plural or singular number respectively. Additionally, the words “herein,” “hereunder,” “above,” “below,” and words of similar import, when used in this application, refer to this application as a whole and not to any particular portions of this application. When the word “or” is used in reference to a list of two or more items, that word covers all of the following interpretations of the word: any of the items in the list, all of the items in the list and any combination of the items in the list.

The above description of embodiments of the integrated security system and corresponding systems and methods is not intended to be exhaustive or to limit the systems and methods to the precise forms disclosed. While specific embodiments of, and examples for, the integrated security system and corresponding systems and methods are described herein for illustrative purposes, various equivalent modifications are possible within the scope of the systems and methods, as those skilled in the relevant art will recognize. The teachings of the integrated security system and corresponding systems and methods provided herein can be applied to other systems and methods, not only for the systems and methods described above.

The elements and acts of the various embodiments described above can be combined to provide further embodiments. These and other changes can be made to the integrated security system and corresponding systems and methods in light of the above detailed description.

In accordance with the embodiments described herein, a wireless system (e.g., radio frequency (RF)) is provided that enables a security provider or consumer to extend the capabilities of an existing RF-capable security system or a non-RF-capable security system that has been upgraded to support RF capabilities. The system includes an RF-capable Gateway device (physically located within RF range of the RF-capable security system) and associated software operating on the Gateway device. The system also includes a web server, application server, and remote database providing a persistent store for information related to the system.

The security systems of an embodiment, referred to herein as the iControl security system or integrated security system, extend the value of traditional home security by adding broadband access and the advantages of remote home monitoring and home control through the formation of a security network including components of the integrated security system integrated with a conventional premise security system and a premise local area network (LAN). With the integrated security system, conventional home security sensors, cameras, touchscreen keypads, lighting controls, and/or Internet Protocol (IP) devices in the home (or business) become connected devices that are accessible anywhere in the world from a web browser, mobile phone or through content-enabled touchscreens. The integrated security system experience allows security operators to both extend the value proposition of their monitored security systems and reach new consumers that include broadband users interested in staying connected to their family, home and property when they are away from home.

The integrated security system of an embodiment includes security servers (also referred to herein as iConnect servers or security network servers) and an iHub gateway (also referred to herein as the gateway, the iHub, or the iHub client) that couples or integrates into a home network (e.g., LAN) and communicates directly with the home security panel, in both wired and wireless installations. The security system of an embodiment automatically discovers the security system components (e.g., sensors, etc.) belonging to the security system and connected to a control panel of the security system and provides consumers with full two-way access via web and mobile portals. The gateway supports various wireless protocols and can interconnect with a wide range of control panels offered by security system providers. Service providers and users can then extend the system's capabilities with the additional IP cameras, lighting modules or security devices such as interactive touchscreen keypads. The integrated security system adds an enhanced value to these security systems by enabling consumers to stay connected through email and SMS alerts, photo push, event-based video capture and rule-based monitoring and notifications. This solution extends the reach of home security to households with broadband access.

The integrated security system builds upon the foundation afforded by traditional security systems by layering broadband and mobile access, IP cameras, interactive touchscreens, and an open approach to home automation on top of traditional security system configurations. The integrated security system is easily installed and managed by the security operator, and simplifies the traditional security installation process, as described below.

The integrated security system provides an open systems solution to the home security market. As such, the foundation of the integrated security system customer premises equipment (CPE) approach has been to abstract devices, and allows applications to manipulate and manage multiple devices from any vendor. The integrated security system DeviceConnect technology that enables this capability supports protocols, devices, and panels from GE Security and Honeywell, as well as consumer devices using Z-Wave, IP cameras (e.g., Ethernet, wifi, and Homeplug), and IP touchscreens. The DeviceConnect is a device abstraction layer that enables any device or protocol layer to interoperate with integrated security system components. This architecture enables the addition of new devices supporting any of these interfaces, as well as add entirely new protocols.

The benefit of DeviceConnect is that it provides supplier flexibility. The same consistent touchscreen, web, and mobile user experience operate unchanged on whatever security equipment selected by a security system provider, with the system provider's choice of IP cameras, backend data center and central station software.

The integrated security system provides a complete system that integrates or layers on top of a conventional host security system available from a security system provider. The security system provider therefore can select different components or configurations to offer (e.g., CDMA, GPRS, no cellular, etc.) as well as have iControl modify the integrated security system configuration for the system provider's specific needs (e.g., change the functionality of the web or mobile portal, add a GE or Honeywell-compatible TouchScreen, etc.).

The integrated security system integrates with the security system provider infrastructure for central station reporting directly via Broadband and GPRS alarm transmissions. Traditional dial-up reporting is supported via the standard panel connectivity. Additionally, the integrated security system provides interfaces for advanced functionality to the CMS, including enhanced alarm events, system installation optimizations, system test verification, video verification, 2-way voice over IP and GSM.

The integrated security system is an IP centric system that includes broadband connectivity so that the gateway augments the existing security system with broadband and GPRS connectivity. If broadband is down or unavailable GPRS may be used, for example. The integrated security system supports GPRS connectivity using an optional wireless package that includes a GPRS modem in the gateway. The integrated security system treats the GPRS connection as a higher cost though flexible option for data transfers. In an embodiment the GPRS connection is only used to route alarm events (e.g., for cost), however the gateway can be configured (e.g., through the iConnect server interface) to act as a primary channel and pass any or all events over GPRS. Consequently, the integrated security system does not interfere with the current plain old telephone service (POTS) security panel interface. Alarm events can still be routed through POTS; however the gateway also allows such events to be routed through a broadband or GPRS connection as well. The integrated security system provides a web application interface to the CSR tool suite as well as XML web services interfaces for programmatic integration between the security system provider's existing call center products. The integrated security system includes, for example, APIs that allow the security system provider to integrate components of the integrated security system into a custom call center interface. The APIs include XML web service APIs for integration of existing security system provider call center applications with the integrated security system service. All functionality available in the CSR Web application is provided with these API sets. The Java and XML-based APIs of the integrated security system support provisioning, billing, system administration, CSR, central station, portal user interfaces, and content management functions, to name a few. The integrated security system can provide a customized interface to the security system provider's billing system, or alternatively can provide security system developers with APIs and support in the integration effort.

The integrated security system provides or includes business component interfaces for provisioning, administration, and customer care to name a few. Standard templates and examples are provided with a defined customer professional services engagement to help integrate OSS/BSS systems of a Service Provider with the integrated security system.

The integrated security system components support and allow for the integration of customer account creation and deletion with a security system. The iConnect APIs provides access to the provisioning and account management system in iConnect and provide full support for account creation, provisioning, and deletion. Depending on the requirements of the security system provider, the iConnect APIs can be used to completely customize any aspect of the integrated security system backend operational system.

The integrated security system includes a gateway that supports the following standards-based interfaces, to name a few: Ethernet IP communications via Ethernet ports on the gateway, and standard XML/TCP/IP protocols and ports are employed over secured SSL sessions; USB 2.0 via ports on the gateway; 802.11b/g/n IP communications; GSM/GPRS RF WAN communications; CDMA 1×RTT RF WAN communications (optional, can also support EVDO and 3G technologies).

The gateway supports the following proprietary interfaces, to name a few: interfaces including Dialog RF network (319.5 MHz) and RS485 Superbus 2000 wired interface; RF mesh network (908 MHz); and interfaces including RF network (345 MHz) and RS485/RS232bus wired interfaces.

Regarding security for the IP communications (e.g., authentication, authorization, encryption, anti-spoofing, etc), the integrated security system uses SSL to encrypt all IP traffic, using server and client-certificates for authentication, as well as authentication in the data sent over the SSL-encrypted channel. For encryption, integrated security system issues public/private key pairs at the time/place of manufacture, and certificates are not stored in any online storage in an embodiment.

The integrated security system does not need any special rules at the customer premise and/or at the security system provider central station because the integrated security system makes outgoing connections using TCP over the standard HTTP and HTTPS ports. Provided outbound TCP connections are allowed then no special requirements on the firewalls are necessary.

FIG. 1 is a block diagram of the integrated security system 100, under an embodiment. The integrated security system 100 of an embodiment includes the gateway 102 and the security servers 104 coupled to the conventional home security system 110. At a customer's home or business, the gateway 102 connects and manages the diverse variety of home security and self-monitoring devices. The gateway 102 communicates with the iConnect Servers 104 located in the service provider's data center 106 (or hosted in integrated security system data center), with the communication taking place via a communication network 108 or other network (e.g., cellular network, internet, etc.). These servers 104 manage the system integrations necessary to deliver the integrated system service described herein. The combination of the gateway 102 and the iConnect servers 104 enable a wide variety of remote client devices 120 (e.g., PCs, mobile phones and PDAs) allowing users to remotely stay in touch with their home, business and family. In addition, the technology allows home security and self-monitoring information, as well as relevant third party content such as traffic and weather, to be presented in intuitive ways within the home, such as on advanced touchscreen keypads.

The integrated security system service (also referred to as iControl service) can be managed by a service provider via browser-based Maintenance and Service Management applications that are provided with the iConnect Servers. Or, if desired, the service can be more tightly integrated with existing OSS/BSS and service delivery systems via the iConnect web services-based XML APIs.

The integrated security system service can also coordinate the sending of alarms to the home security Central Monitoring Station (CMS) 199. Alarms are passed to the CMS 199 using standard protocols such as Contact ID or SIA and can be generated from the home security panel location as well as by iConnect server 104 conditions (such as lack of communications with the integrated security system). In addition, the link between the security servers 104 and CMS 199 provides tighter integration between home security and self-monitoring devices and the gateway 102. Such integration enables advanced security capabilities such as the ability for CMS personnel to view photos taken at the time a burglary alarm was triggered. For maximum security, the gateway 102 and iConnect servers 104 support the use of a mobile network (both GPRS and CDMA options are available) as a backup to the primary broadband connection.

The integrated security system service is delivered by hosted servers running software components that communicate with a variety of client types while interacting with other systems. FIG. 2 is a block diagram of components of the integrated security system 100, under an embodiment. Following is a more detailed description of the components.

The iConnect servers 104 support a diverse collection of clients 120 ranging from mobile devices, to PCs, to in-home security devices, to a service provider's internal systems. Most clients 120 are used by end-users, but there are also a number of clients 120 that are used to operate the service.

Clients 120 used by end-users of the integrated security system 100 include, but are not limited to, the following:

-   -   Clients based on gateway client applications 202 (e.g., a         processor-based device running the gateway technology that         manages home security and automation devices).     -   A web browser 204 accessing a Web Portal application, performing         end-user configuration and customization of the integrated         security system service as well as monitoring of in-home device         status, viewing photos and video, etc. Device and user         management can also be performed by this portal application.     -   A mobile device 206 (e.g., PDA, mobile phone, etc.) accessing         the integrated security system Mobile Portal. This type of         client 206 is used by end-users to view system status and         perform operations on devices (e.g., turning on a lamp, arming a         security panel, etc.) rather than for system configuration tasks         such as adding a new device or user.     -   PC or browser-based “widget” containers 208 that present         integrated security system service content, as well as other         third-party content, in simple, targeted ways (e.g. a widget         that resides on a PC desktop and shows live video from a single         in-home camera). “Widget” as used herein means applications or         programs in the system.     -   Touchscreen home security keypads 208 and advanced in-home         devices that present a variety of content widgets via an         intuitive touchscreen user interface.     -   Notification recipients 210 (e.g., cell phones that receive         SMS-based notifications when certain events occur (or don't         occur), email clients that receive an email message with similar         information, etc.).

Custom-built clients (not shown) that access the iConnect web services XML API to interact with users' home security and self-monitoring information in new and unique ways. Such clients could include new types of mobile devices, or complex applications where integrated security system content is integrated into a broader set of application features.

In addition to the end-user clients, the iConnect servers 104 support PC browser-based Service Management clients that manage the ongoing operation of the overall service. These clients run applications that handle tasks such as provisioning, service monitoring, customer support and reporting.

There are numerous types of server components of the iConnect servers 104 of an embodiment including, but not limited to, the following: Business Components which manage information about all of the home security and self-monitoring devices; End-User Application Components which display that information for users and access the Business Components via published XML APIs; and Service Management Application Components which enable operators to administer the service (these components also access the Business Components via the XML APIs, and also via published SNMP MIBs).

The server components provide access to, and management of, the objects associated with an integrated security system installation. The top-level object is the “network.” It is a location where a gateway 102 is located, and is also commonly referred to as a site or premises; the premises can include any type of structure (e.g., home, office, warehouse, etc.) at which a gateway 102 is located. Users can only access the networks to which they have been granted permission. Within a network, every object monitored by the gateway 102 is called a device. Devices include the sensors, cameras, home security panels and automation devices, as well as the controller or processor-based device running the gateway applications.

Various types of interactions are possible between the objects in a system. Automations define actions that occur as a result of a change in state of a device. For example, take a picture with the front entry camera when the front door sensor changes to “open”. Notifications are messages sent to users to indicate that something has occurred, such as the front door going to “open” state, or has not occurred (referred to as an iWatch notification). Schedules define changes in device states that are to take place at predefined days and times. For example, set the security panel to “Armed” mode every weeknight at 11:00 pm.

The iConnect Business Components are responsible for orchestrating all of the low-level service management activities for the integrated security system service. They define all of the users and devices associated with a network (site), analyze how the devices interact, and trigger associated actions (such as sending notifications to users). All changes in device states are monitored and logged. The Business Components also manage all interactions with external systems as required, including sending alarms and other related self-monitoring data to the home security Central Monitoring System (CMS) 199. The Business Components are implemented as portable Java J2EE Servlets, but are not so limited.

The following iConnect Business Components manage the main elements of the integrated security system service, but the embodiment is not so limited:

A Registry Manager 220 defines and manages users and networks. This component is responsible for the creation, modification and termination of users and networks. It is also where a user's access to networks is defined.

A Network Manager 222 defines and manages security and self-monitoring devices that are deployed on a network (site). This component handles the creation, modification, deletion and configuration of the devices, as well as the creation of automations, schedules and notification rules associated with those devices.

A Data Manager 224 manages access to current and logged state data for an existing network and its devices. This component specifically does not provide any access to network management capabilities, such as adding new devices to a network, which are handled exclusively by the Network Manager 222.

To achieve optimal performance for all types of queries, data for current device states is stored separately from historical state data (a.k.a. “logs”) in the database. A Log Data Manager 226 performs ongoing transfers of current device state data to the historical data log tables.

Additional iConnect Business Components handle direct communications with certain clients and other systems, for example:

An iHub Manager 228 directly manages all communications with gateway clients, including receiving information about device state changes, changing the configuration of devices, and pushing new versions of the gateway client to the hardware it is running on.

A Notification Manager 230 is responsible for sending all notifications to clients via SMS (mobile phone messages), email (via a relay server like an SMTP email server), etc.

An Alarm and CMS Manager 232 sends critical server-generated alarm events to the home security Central Monitoring Station (CMS) and manages all other communications of integrated security system service data to and from the CMS.

The Element Management System (EMS) 234 is an iControl Business Component that manages all activities associated with service installation, scaling and monitoring, and filters and packages service operations data for use by service management applications. The SNMP MIBs published by the EMS can also be incorporated into any third party monitoring system if desired.

The iConnect Business Components store information about the objects that they manage in the iControl Service Database 240 and in the iControl Content Store 242. The iControl Content Store is used to store media objects like video, photos and widget content, while the Service Database stores information about users, networks, and devices. Database interaction is performed via a JDBC interface. For security purposes, the Business Components manage all data storage and retrieval.

The iControl Business Components provide web services-based APIs that application components use to access the Business Components' capabilities. Functions of application components include presenting integrated security system service data to end-users, performing administrative duties, and integrating with external systems and back-office applications.

The primary published APIs for the iConnect Business Components include, but are not limited to, the following:

A Registry Manager API 252 provides access to the Registry Manager Business Component's functionality, allowing management of networks and users.

A Network Manager API 254 provides access to the Network Manager Business Component's functionality, allowing management of devices on a network.

A Data Manager API 256 provides access to the Data Manager Business Component's functionality, such as setting and retrieving (current and historical) data about device states.

A Provisioning API 258 provides a simple way to create new networks and configure initial default properties.

Each API of an embodiment includes two modes of access: Java API or XML API. The XML APIs are published as web services so that they can be easily accessed by applications or servers over a network. The Java APIs are a programmer-friendly wrapper for the XML APIs. Application components and integrations written in Java should generally use the Java APIs rather than the XML APIs directly.

The iConnect Business Components also have an XML-based interface 260 for quickly adding support for new devices to the integrated security system. This interface 260, referred to as DeviceConnect 260, is a flexible, standards-based mechanism for defining the properties of new devices and how they can be managed. Although the format is flexible enough to allow the addition of any type of future device, pre-defined XML profiles are currently available for adding common types of devices such as sensors (SensorConnect), home security panels (PanelConnect) and IP cameras (CameraConnect).

The iConnect End-User Application Components deliver the user interfaces that run on the different types of clients supported by the integrated security system service. The components are written in portable Java J2EE technology (e.g., as Java Servlets, as JavaServer Pages (JSPs), etc.) and they all interact with the iControl Business Components via the published APIs.

The following End-User Application Components generate CSS-based HTML/JavaScript that is displayed on the target client. These applications can be dynamically branded with partner-specific logos and URL links (such as Customer Support, etc.). The End-User Application Components of an embodiment include, but are not limited to, the following:

An iControl Activation Application 270 that delivers the first application that a user sees when they set up the integrated security system service. This wizard-based web browser application securely associates a new user with a purchased gateway and the other devices included with it as a kit (if any). It primarily uses functionality published by the Provisioning API.

An iControl Web Portal Application 272 runs on PC browsers and delivers the web-based interface to the integrated security system service. This application allows users to manage their networks (e.g. add devices and create automations) as well as to view/change device states, and manage pictures and videos. Because of the wide scope of capabilities of this application, it uses three different Business Component APIs that include the Registry Manager API, Network Manager API, and Data Manager API, but the embodiment is not so limited.

An iControl Mobile Portal 274 is a small-footprint web-based interface that runs on mobile phones and PDAs. This interface is optimized for remote viewing of device states and pictures/videos rather than network management. As such, its interaction with the Business Components is primarily via the Data Manager API.

Custom portals and targeted client applications can be provided that leverage the same Business Component APIs used by the above applications.

A Content Manager Application Component 276 delivers content to a variety of clients. It sends multimedia-rich user interface components to widget container clients (both PC and browser-based), as well as to advanced touchscreen keypad clients. In addition to providing content directly to end-user devices, the Content Manager 276 provides widget-based user interface components to satisfy requests from other Application Components such as the iControl Web 272 and Mobile 274 portals.

A number of Application Components are responsible for overall management of the service. These pre-defined applications, referred to as Service Management Application Components, are configured to offer off-the-shelf solutions for production management of the integrated security system service including provisioning, overall service monitoring, customer support, and reporting, for example. The Service Management Application Components of an embodiment include, but are not limited to, the following:

A Service Management Application 280 allows service administrators to perform activities associated with service installation, scaling and monitoring/alerting. This application interacts heavily with the Element Management System (EMS) Business Component to execute its functionality, and also retrieves its monitoring data from that component via protocols such as SNMP MIBs.

A Kitting Application 282 is used by employees performing service provisioning tasks. This application allows home security and self-monitoring devices to be associated with gateways during the warehouse kitting process.

A CSR Application and Report Generator 284 is used by personnel supporting the integrated security system service, such as CSRs resolving end-user issues and employees enquiring about overall service usage. The push of new gateway firmware to deployed gateways is also managed by this application.

The iConnect servers 104 also support custom-built integrations with a service provider's existing OSS/BSS, CSR and service delivery systems 290. Such systems can access the iConnect web services XML API to transfer data to and from the iConnect servers 104. These types of integrations can compliment or replace the PC browser-based Service Management applications, depending on service provider needs.

As described above, the integrated security system of an embodiment includes a gateway, or iHub. The gateway of an embodiment includes a device that is deployed in the home or business and couples or connects the various third-party cameras, home security panels, sensors and devices to the iConnect server over a WAN connection as described in detail herein. The gateway couples to the home network and communicates directly with the home security panel in both wired and wireless sensor installations. The gateway is configured to be low-cost, reliable and thin so that it complements the integrated security system network-based architecture.

The gateway supports various wireless protocols and can interconnect with a wide range of home security control panels. Service providers and users can then extend the system's capabilities by adding IP cameras, lighting modules and additional security devices. The gateway is configurable to be integrated into many consumer appliances, including set-top boxes, routers and security panels. The small and efficient footprint of the gateway enables this portability and versatility, thereby simplifying and reducing the overall cost of the deployment.

FIG. 3 is a block diagram of the gateway 102 including gateway software or applications, under an embodiment. The gateway software architecture is relatively thin and efficient, thereby simplifying its integration into other consumer appliances such as set-top boxes, routers, touch screens and security panels. The software architecture also provides a high degree of security against unauthorized access. This section describes the various key components of the gateway software architecture.

The gateway application layer 302 is the main program that orchestrates the operations performed by the gateway. The Security Engine 304 provides robust protection against intentional and unintentional intrusion into the integrated security system network from the outside world (both from inside the premises as well as from the WAN). The Security Engine 304 of an embodiment comprises one or more sub-modules or components that perform functions including, but not limited to, the following:

Encryption including 128-bit SSL encryption for gateway and iConnect server communication to protect user data privacy and provide secure communication.

Bi-directional authentication between the gateway and iConnect server in order to prevent unauthorized spoofing and attacks. Data sent from the iConnect server to the gateway application (or vice versa) is digitally signed as an additional layer of security. Digital signing provides both authentication and validation that the data has not been altered in transit.

Camera SSL encapsulation because picture and video traffic offered by off-the-shelf networked IP cameras is not secure when traveling over the Internet. The gateway provides for 128-bit SSL encapsulation of the user picture and video data sent over the internet for complete user security and privacy.

802.11b/g/n with WPA-2 security to ensure that wireless camera communications always takes place using the strongest available protection.

A gateway-enabled device is assigned a unique activation key for activation with an iConnect server. This ensures that only valid gateway-enabled devices can be activated for use with the specific instance of iConnect server in use. Attempts to activate gateway-enabled devices by brute force are detected by the Security Engine. Partners deploying gateway-enabled devices have the knowledge that only a gateway with the correct serial number and activation key can be activated for use with an iConnect server. Stolen devices, devices attempting to masquerade as gateway-enabled devices, and malicious outsiders (or insiders as knowledgeable but nefarious customers) cannot effect other customers' gateway-enabled devices.

As standards evolve, and new encryption and authentication methods are proven to be useful, and older mechanisms proven to be breakable, the security manager can be upgraded “over the air” to provide new and better security for communications between the iConnect server and the gateway application, and locally at the premises to remove any risk of eavesdropping on camera communications.

A Remote Firmware Download module 306 allows for seamless and secure updates to the gateway firmware through the iControl Maintenance Application on the server 104, providing a transparent, hassle-free mechanism for the service provider to deploy new features and bug fixes to the installed user base. The firmware download mechanism is tolerant of connection loss, power interruption and user interventions (both intentional and unintentional). Such robustness reduces down time and customer support issues. Gateway firmware can be remotely download either for one gateway at a time, a group of gateways, or in batches.

The Automations engine 308 manages the user-defined rules of interaction between the different devices (e.g. when door opens turn on the light). Though the automation rules are programmed and reside at the portal/server level, they are cached at the gateway level in order to provide short latency between device triggers and actions.

DeviceConnect 310 includes definitions of all supported devices (e.g., cameras, security panels, sensors, etc.) using a standardized plug-in architecture. The DeviceConnect module 310 offers an interface that can be used to quickly add support for any new device as well as enabling interoperability between devices that use different technologies/protocols. For common device types, pre-defined sub-modules have been defined, making supporting new devices of these types even easier. SensorConnect 312 is provided for adding new sensors, CameraConnect 316 for adding IP cameras, and PanelConnect 314 for adding home security panels.

The Schedules engine 318 is responsible for executing the user defined schedules (e.g., take a picture every five minutes; every day at 8 am set temperature to 65 degrees Fahrenheit, etc.). Though the schedules are programmed and reside at the iConnect server level they are sent to the scheduler within the gateway application. The Schedules Engine 318 then interfaces with SensorConnect 312 to ensure that scheduled events occur at precisely the desired time.

The Device Management module 320 is in charge of all discovery, installation and configuration of both wired and wireless IP devices (e.g., cameras, etc.) coupled or connected to the system. Networked IP devices, such as those used in the integrated security system, require user configuration of many IP and security parameters—to simplify the user experience and reduce the customer support burden, the device management module of an embodiment handles the details of this configuration. The device management module also manages the video routing module described below.

The video routing engine 322 is responsible for delivering seamless video streams to the user with zero-configuration. Through a multi-step, staged approach the video routing engine uses a combination of UPnP port-forwarding, relay server routing and STUN/TURN peer-to-peer routing.

FIG. 4 is a block diagram of components of the gateway 102, under an embodiment. Depending on the specific set of functionality desired by the service provider deploying the integrated security system service, the gateway 102 can use any of a number of processors 402, due to the small footprint of the gateway application firmware. In an embodiment, the gateway could include the Broadcom BCM5354 as the processor for example. In addition, the gateway 102 includes memory (e.g., FLASH 404, RAM 406, etc.) and any number of input/output (I/O) ports 408.

Referring to the WAN portion 410 of the gateway 102, the gateway 102 of an embodiment can communicate with the iConnect server using a number of communication types and/or protocols, for example Broadband 412, GPRS 414 and/or Public Switched Telephone Network (PTSN) 416 to name a few. In general, broadband communication 412 is the primary means of connection between the gateway 102 and the iConnect server 104 and the GPRS/CDMA 414 and/or PSTN 416 interfaces acts as back-up for fault tolerance in case the user's broadband connection fails for whatever reason, but the embodiment is not so limited.

Referring to the LAN portion 420 of the gateway 102, various protocols and physical transceivers can be used to communicate to off-the-shelf sensors and cameras. The gateway 102 is protocol-agnostic and technology-agnostic and as such can easily support almost any device networking protocol. The gateway 102 can, for example, support GE and Honeywell security RF protocols 422, Z-Wave 424, serial (RS232 and RS485) 426 for direct connection to security panels as well as WiFi 428 (802.11b/g) for communication to WiFi cameras.

The integrated security system includes couplings or connections among a variety of IP devices or components, and the device management module is in charge of the discovery, installation and configuration of the IP devices coupled or connected to the system, as described above. The integrated security system of an embodiment uses a “sandbox” network to discover and manage all IP devices coupled or connected as components of the system. The IP devices of an embodiment include wired devices, wireless devices, cameras, interactive touchscreens, and security panels to name a few. These devices can be wired via ethernet cable or Wifi devices, all of which are secured within the sandbox network, as described below. The “sandbox” network is described in detail below.

FIG. 5 is a block diagram 500 of network or premise device integration with a premise network 250, under an embodiment. In an embodiment, network devices 255-257 are coupled to the gateway 102 using a secure network coupling or connection such as SSL over an encrypted 802.11 link (utilizing for example WPA-2 security for the wireless encryption). The network coupling or connection between the gateway 102 and the network devices 255-257 is a private coupling or connection in that it is segregated from any other network couplings or connections. The gateway 102 is coupled to the premise router/firewall 252 via a coupling with a premise LAN 250. The premise router/firewall 252 is coupled to a broadband modem 251, and the broadband modem 251 is coupled to a WAN 200 or other network outside the premise. The gateway 102 thus enables or forms a separate wireless network, or sub-network, that includes some number of devices and is coupled or connected to the LAN 250 of the host premises. The gateway sub-network can include, but is not limited to, any number of other devices like WiFi IP cameras, security panels (e.g., IP-enabled), and security touchscreens, to name a few. The gateway 102 manages or controls the sub-network separately from the LAN 250 and transfers data and information between components of the sub-network and the LAN 250/WAN 200, but is not so limited. Additionally, other network devices 254 can be coupled to the LAN 250 without being coupled to the gateway 102.

FIG. 6 is a block diagram 600 of network or premise device integration with a premise network 250, under an alternative embodiment. The network or premise devices 255-257 are coupled to the gateway 102. The network coupling or connection between the gateway 102 and the network devices 255-257 is a private coupling or connection in that it is segregated from any other network couplings or connections. The gateway 102 is coupled or connected between the premise router/firewall 252 and the broadband modem 251. The broadband modem 251 is coupled to a WAN 200 or other network outside the premise, while the premise router/firewall 252 is coupled to a premise LAN 250. As a result of its location between the broadband modem 251 and the premise router/firewall 252, the gateway 102 can be configured or function as the premise router routing specified data between the outside network (e.g., WAN 200) and the premise router/firewall 252 of the LAN 250. As described above, the gateway 102 in this configuration enables or forms a separate wireless network, or sub-network, that includes the network or premise devices 255-257 and is coupled or connected between the LAN 250 of the host premises and the WAN 200. The gateway sub-network can include, but is not limited to, any number of network or premise devices 255-257 like WiFi IP cameras, security panels (e.g., IP-enabled), and security touchscreens, to name a few. The gateway 102 manages or controls the sub-network separately from the LAN 250 and transfers data and information between components of the sub-network and the LAN 250/WAN 200, but is not so limited. Additionally, other network devices 254 can be coupled to the LAN 250 without being coupled to the gateway 102.

The examples described above with reference to FIGS. 5 and 6 are presented only as examples of IP device integration. The integrated security system is not limited to the type, number and/or combination of IP devices shown and described in these examples, and any type, number and/or combination of IP devices is contemplated within the scope of this disclosure as capable of being integrated with the premise network.

The integrated security system of an embodiment includes a touchscreen (also referred to as the iControl touchscreen or integrated security system touchscreen), as described above, which provides core security keypad functionality, content management and presentation, and embedded systems design. The networked security touchscreen system of an embodiment enables a consumer or security provider to easily and automatically install, configure and manage the security system and touchscreen located at a customer premise. Using this system the customer may access and control the local security system, local IP devices such as cameras, local sensors and control devices (such as lighting controls or pipe freeze sensors), as well as the local security system panel and associated security sensors (such as door/window, motion, and smoke detectors). The customer premise may be a home, business, and/or other location equipped with a wired or wireless broadband IP connection.

The system of an embodiment includes a touchscreen with a configurable software user interface and/or a gateway device (e.g., iHub) that couples or connects to a premise security panel through a wired or wireless connection, and a remote server that provides access to content and information from the premises devices to a user when they are remote from the home. The touchscreen supports broadband and/or WAN wireless connectivity. In this embodiment, the touchscreen incorporates an IP broadband connection (e.g., Wifi radio, Ethernet port, etc.), and/or a cellular radio (e.g., GPRS/GSM, CDMA, WiMax, etc.). The touchscreen described herein can be used as one or more of a security system interface panel and a network user interface (UI) that provides an interface to interact with a network (e.g., LAN, WAN, internet, etc.).

The touchscreen of an embodiment provides an integrated touchscreen and security panel as an all-in-one device. Once integrated using the touchscreen, the touchscreen and a security panel of a premise security system become physically co-located in one device, and the functionality of both may even be co-resident on the same CPU and memory (though this is not required).

The touchscreen of an embodiment also provides an integrated IP video and touchscreen UI. As such, the touchscreen supports one or more standard video CODECs/players (e.g., H.264, Flash Video, MOV, MPEG4, M-JPEG, etc.). The touchscreen UI then provides a mechanism (such as a camera or video widget) to play video. In an embodiment the video is streamed live from an IP video camera. In other embodiments the video comprises video clips or photos sent from an IP camera or from a remote location.

The touchscreen of an embodiment provides a configurable user interface system that includes a configuration supporting use as a security touchscreen. In this embodiment, the touchscreen utilizes a modular user interface that allows components to be modified easily by a service provider, an installer, or even the end user. Examples of such a modular approach include using Flash widgets, HTML-based widgets, or other downloadable code modules such that the user interface of the touchscreen can be updated and modified while the application is running. In an embodiment the touchscreen user interface modules can be downloaded over the internet. For example, a new security configuration widget can be downloaded from a standard web server, and the touchscreen then loads such configuration app into memory, and inserts it in place of the old security configuration widget. The touchscreen of an embodiment is configured to provide a self-install user interface.

Embodiments of the networked security touchscreen system described herein include a touchscreen device with a user interface that includes a security toolbar providing one or more functions including arm, disarm, panic, medic, and alert. The touchscreen therefore includes at least one screen having a separate region of the screen dedicated to a security toolbar. The security toolbar of an embodiment is present in the dedicated region at all times that the screen is active.

The touchscreen of an embodiment includes a home screen having a separate region of the screen allocated to managing home-based functions. The home-based functions of an embodiment include managing, viewing, and/or controlling IP video cameras. In this embodiment, regions of the home screen are allocated in the form of widget icons; these widget icons (e.g. for cameras, thermostats, lighting, etc) provide functionality for managing home systems. So, for example, a displayed camera icon, when selected, launches a Camera Widget, and the Camera widget in turn provides access to video from one or more cameras, as well as providing the user with relevant camera controls (take a picture, focus the camera, etc.)

The touchscreen of an embodiment includes a home screen having a separate region of the screen allocated to managing, viewing, and/or controlling internet-based content or applications. For example, the Widget Manager UI presents a region of the home screen (up to and including the entire home screen) where internet widgets icons such as weather, sports, etc. may be accessed). Each of these icons may be selected to launch their respective content services.

The touchscreen of an embodiment is integrated into a premise network using the gateway, as described above. The gateway as described herein functions to enable a separate wireless network, or sub-network, that is coupled, connected, or integrated with another network (e.g., WAN, LAN of the host premises, etc.). The sub-network enabled by the gateway optimizes the installation process for IP devices, like the touchscreen, that couple or connect to the sub-network by segregating these IP devices from other such devices on the network. This segregation of the IP devices of the sub-network further enables separate security and privacy policies to be implemented for these IP devices so that, where the IP devices are dedicated to specific functions (e.g., security), the security and privacy policies can be tailored specifically for the specific functions. Furthermore, the gateway and the sub-network it forms enables the segregation of data traffic, resulting in faster and more efficient data flow between components of the host network, components of the sub-network, and between components of the sub-network and components of the network.

The touchscreen of an embodiment includes a core functional embedded system that includes an embedded operating system, required hardware drivers, and an open system interface to name a few. The core functional embedded system can be provided by or as a component of a conventional security system (e.g., security system available from GE Security). These core functional units are used with components of the integrated security system as described herein. Note that portions of the touchscreen description below may include reference to a host premise security system (e.g., GE security system), but these references are included only as an example and do not limit the touchscreen to integration with any particular security system.

As an example, regarding the core functional embedded system, a reduced memory footprint version of embedded Linux forms the core operating system in an embodiment, and provides basic TCP/IP stack and memory management functions, along with a basic set of low-level graphics primitives. A set of device drivers is also provided or included that offer low-level hardware and network interfaces. In addition to the standard drivers, an interface to the RS 485 bus is included that couples or connects to the security system panel (e.g., GE Concord panel). The interface may, for example, implement the Superbus 2000 protocol, which can then be utilized by the more comprehensive transaction-level security functions implemented in PanelConnect technology (e.g SetAlarmLevel (int level, int partition, char *accessCode)). Power control drivers are also provided.

FIG. 7 is a block diagram of a touchscreen 700 of the integrated security system, under an embodiment. The touchscreen 700 generally includes an application/presentation layer 702 with a resident application 704, and a core engine 706. The touchscreen 700 also includes one or more of the following, but is not so limited: applications of premium services 710, widgets 712, a caching proxy 714, network security 716, network interface 718, security object 720, applications supporting devices 722, PanelConnect API 724, a gateway interface 726, and one or more ports 728.

More specifically, the touchscreen, when configured as a home security device, includes but is not limited to the following application or software modules: RS 485 and/or RS-232 bus security protocols to conventional home security system panel (e.g., GE Concord panel); functional home security classes and interfaces (e.g. Panel ARM state, Sensor status, etc.); Application/Presentation layer or engine; Resident Application; Consumer Home Security Application; installer home security application; core engine; and System bootloader/Software Updater. The core Application engine and system bootloader can also be used to support other advanced content and applications. This provides a seamless interaction between the premise security application and other optional services such as weather widgets or IP cameras.

An alternative configuration of the touchscreen includes a first Application engine for premise security and a second Application engine for all other applications. The integrated security system application engine supports content standards such as HTML, XML, Flash, etc. and enables a rich consumer experience for all ‘widgets’, whether security-based or not. The touchscreen thus provides service providers the ability to use web content creation and management tools to build and download any ‘widgets’ regardless of their functionality.

As discussed above, although the Security Applications have specific low-level functional requirements in order to interface with the premise security system, these applications make use of the same fundamental application facilities as any other ‘widget’, application facilities that include graphical layout, interactivity, application handoff, screen management, and network interfaces, to name a few.

Content management in the touchscreen provides the ability to leverage conventional web development tools, performance optimized for an embedded system, service provider control of accessible content, content reliability in a consumer device, and consistency between ‘widgets’ and seamless widget operational environment. In an embodiment of the integrated security system, widgets are created by web developers and hosted on the integrated security system Content Manager (and stored in the Content Store database). In this embodiment the server component caches the widgets and offers them to consumers through the web-based integrated security system provisioning system. The servers interact with the advanced touchscreen using HTTPS interfaces controlled by the core engine and dynamically download widgets and updates as needed to be cached on the touchscreen. In other embodiments widgets can be accessed directly over a network such as the Internet without needing to go through the iControl Content Manager

Referring to FIG. 7 , the touchscreen system is built on a tiered architecture, with defined interfaces between the Application/Presentation Layer (the Application Engine) on the top, the Core Engine in the middle, and the security panel and gateway APIs at the lower level. The architecture is configured to provide maximum flexibility and ease of maintenance.

The application engine of the touchscreen provides the presentation and interactivity capabilities for all applications (widgets) that run on the touchscreen, including both core security function widgets and third party content widgets. FIG. 8 is an example screenshot 800 of a networked security touchscreen, under an embodiment. This example screenshot 800 includes three interfaces or user interface (UI) components 802-806, but is not so limited. A first UI 802 of the touchscreen includes icons by which a user controls or accesses functions and/or components of the security system (e.g., “Main”, “Panic”, “Medic”, “Fire”, state of the premise alarm system (e.g., disarmed, armed, etc.), etc.); the first UI 802, which is also referred to herein as a security interface, is always presented on the touchscreen. A second UI 804 of the touchscreen includes icons by which a user selects or interacts with services and other network content (e.g., clock, calendar, weather, stocks, news, sports, photos, maps, music, etc.) that is accessible via the touchscreen. The second UI 804 is also referred to herein as a network interface or content interface. A third UI 806 of the touchscreen includes icons by which a user selects or interacts with additional services or componets (e.g., intercom control, security, cameras coupled to the system in particular regions (e.g., front door, baby, etc.) available via the touchscreen.

A component of the application engine is the Presentation Engine, which includes a set of libraries that implement the standards-based widget content (e.g., XML, HTML, JavaScript, Flash) layout and interactivity. This engine provides the widget with interfaces to dynamically load both graphics and application logic from third parties, support high level data description language as well as standard graphic formats. The set of web content-based functionality available to a widget developer is extended by specific touchscreen functions implemented as local web services by the Core Engine.

The resident application of the touchscreen is the master service that controls the interaction of all widgets in the system, and enforces the business and security rules required by the service provider. For example, the resident application determines the priority of widgets, thereby enabling a home security widget to override resource requests from a less critical widget (e.g. a weather widget). The resident application also monitors widget behavior, and responds to client or server requests for cache updates.

The core engine of the touchscreen manages interaction with other components of the integrated security system, and provides an interface through which the resident application and authorized widgets can get information about the home security system, set alarms, install sensors, etc. At the lower level, the Core Engine's main interactions are through the PanelConnect API, which handles all communication with the security panel, and the gateway Interface, which handles communication with the gateway. In an embodiment, both the iHub Interface and PanelConnect API are resident and operating on the touchscreen. In another embodiment, the PanelConnect API runs on the gateway or other device that provides security system interaction and is accessed by the touchscreen through a web services interface.

The Core Engine also handles application and service level persistent and cached memory functions, as well as the dynamic provisioning of content and widgets, including but not limited to: flash memory management, local widget and content caching, widget version management (download, cache flush new/old content versions), as well as the caching and synchronization of user preferences. As a portion of these services the Core engine incorporates the bootloader functionality that is responsible for maintaining a consistent software image on the touchscreen, and acts as the client agent for all software updates. The bootloader is configured to ensure full update redundancy so that unsuccessful downloads cannot corrupt the integrated security system.

Video management is provided as a set of web services by the Core Engine. Video management includes the retrieval and playback of local video feeds as well as remote control and management of cameras (all through iControl CameraConnect technology).

Both the high level application layer and the mid-level core engine of the touchscreen can make calls to the network. Any call to the network made by the application layer is automatically handed off to a local caching proxy, which determines whether the request should be handled locally. Many of the requests from the application layer are web services API requests, although such requests could be satisfied by the iControl servers, they are handled directly by the touchscreen and the gateway. Requests that get through the caching proxy are checked against a white list of acceptable sites, and, if they match, are sent off through the network interface to the gateway. Included in the Network Subsystem is a set of network services including HTTP, HTTPS, and server-level authentication functions to manage the secure client-server interface. Storage and management of certificates is incorporated as a part of the network services layer.

Server components of the integrated security system servers support interactive content services on the touchscreen. These server components include, but are not limited to the content manager, registry manager, network manager, and global registry, each of which is described herein.

The Content Manager oversees aspects of handling widget data and raw content on the touchscreen. Once created and validated by the service provider, widgets are ‘ingested’ to the Content Manager, and then become available as downloadable services through the integrated security system Content Management APIs. The Content manager maintains versions and timestamp information, and connects to the raw data contained in the backend Content Store database. When a widget is updated (or new content becomes available) all clients registering interest in a widget are systematically updated as needed (a process that can be configured at an account, locale, or system-wide level).

The Registry Manager handles user data, and provisioning accounts, including information about widgets the user has decided to install, and the user preferences for these widgets.

The Network Manager handles getting and setting state for all devices on the integrated security system network (e.g., sensors, panels, cameras, etc.). The Network manager synchronizes with the gateway, the advanced touchscreen, and the subscriber database.

The Global Registry is a primary starting point server for all client services, and is a logical referral service that abstracts specific server locations/addresses from clients (touchscreen, gateway 102, desktop widgets, etc.). This approach enables easy scaling/migration of server farms.

The touchscreen of an embodiment operates wirelessly with a premise security system. The touchscreen of an embodiment incorporates an RF transceiver component that either communicates directly with the sensors and/or security panel over the panel's proprietary RF frequency, or the touchscreen communicates wirelessly to the gateway over 802.11, Ethernet, or other IP-based communications channel, as described in detail herein. In the latter case the gateway implements the PanelConnect interface and communicates directly to the security panel and/or sensors over wireless or wired networks as described in detail above.

The touchscreen of an embodiment is configured to operate with multiple security systems through the use of an abstracted security system interface. In this embodiment, the PanelConnect API can be configured to support a plurality of proprietary security system interfaces, either simultaneously or individually as described herein. In one embodiment of this approach, the touchscreen incorporates multiple physical interfaces to security panels (e.g. GE Security RS-485, Honeywell RF, etc.) in addition to the PanelConnect API implemented to support multiple security interfaces. The change needed to support this in PanelConnect is a configuration parameter specifying the panel type connection that is being utilized.

So for example, the setARMState( ) function is called with an additional parameter (e.g., Armstate=setARMState(type=“ARM STAY|ARM AWAY|DISARM”, Parameters=“ExitDelay=30|Lights=OFF”, panelType=“GE Concord4 RS485”)). The ‘panelType’ parameter is used by the setARMState function (and in practice by all of the PanelConnect functions) to select an algorithm appropriate to the specific panel out of a plurality of alogorithms.

The touchscreen of an embodiment is self-installable. Consequently, the touchscreen provides a ‘wizard’ approach similar to that used in traditional computer installations (e.g. InstallShield). The wizard can be resident on the touchscreen, accessible through a web interface, or both. In one embodiment of a touchscreen self-installation process, the service provider can associate devices (sensors, touchscreens, security panels, lighting controls, etc.) remotely using a web-based administrator interface.

The touchscreen of an embodiment includes a battery backup system for a security touchscreen. The touchscreen incorporates a standard Li-ion or other battery and charging circuitry to allow continued operation in the event of a power outage. In an embodiment the battery is physically located and connected within the touchscreen enclosure. In another embodiment the battery is located as a part of the power transformer, or in between the power transformer and the touchscreen.

The example configurations of the integrated security system described above with reference to FIGS. 5 and 6 include a gateway that is a separate device, and the touchscreen couples to the gateway. However, in an alternative embodiment, the gateway device and its functionality can be incorporated into the touchscreen so that the device management module, which is now a component of or included in the touchscreen, is in charge of the discovery, installation and configuration of the IP devices coupled or connected to the system, as described above. The integrated security system with the integrated touchscreen/gateway uses the same “sandbox” network to discover and manage all IP devices coupled or connected as components of the system.

The touchscreen of this alternative embodiment integrates the components of the gateway with the components of the touchscreen as described herein. More specifically, the touchscreen of this alternative embodiment includes software or applications described above with reference to FIG. 3 . In this alternative embodiment, the touchscreen includes the gateway application layer 302 as the main program that orchestrates the operations performed by the gateway. A Security Engine 304 of the touchscreen provides robust protection against intentional and unintentional intrusion into the integrated security system network from the outside world (both from inside the premises as well as from the WAN). The Security Engine 304 of an embodiment comprises one or more sub-modules or components that perform functions including, but not limited to, the following:

Encryption including 128-bit SSL encryption for gateway and iConnect server communication to protect user data privacy and provide secure communication.

Bi-directional authentication between the touchscreen and iConnect server in order to prevent unauthorized spoofing and attacks. Data sent from the iConnect server to the gateway application (or vice versa) is digitally signed as an additional layer of security. Digital signing provides both authentication and validation that the data has not been altered in transit.

Camera SSL encapsulation because picture and video traffic offered by off-the-shelf networked IP cameras is not secure when traveling over the Internet. The touchscreen provides for 128-bit SSL encapsulation of the user picture and video data sent over the internet for complete user security and privacy.

802.11b/g/n with WPA-2 security to ensure that wireless camera communications always takes place using the strongest available protection.

A touchscreen-enabled device is assigned a unique activation key for activation with an iConnect server. This ensures that only valid gateway-enabled devices can be activated for use with the specific instance of iConnect server in use. Attempts to activate gateway-enabled devices by brute force are detected by the Security Engine. Partners deploying touchscreen-enabled devices have the knowledge that only a gateway with the correct serial number and activation key can be activated for use with an iConnect server. Stolen devices, devices attempting to masquerade as gateway-enabled devices, and malicious outsiders (or insiders as knowledgeable but nefarious customers) cannot effect other customers' gateway-enabled devices.

As standards evolve, and new encryption and authentication methods are proven to be useful, and older mechanisms proven to be breakable, the security manager can be upgraded “over the air” to provide new and better security for communications between the iConnect server and the gateway application, and locally at the premises to remove any risk of eavesdropping on camera communications.

A Remote Firmware Download module 306 of the touchscreen allows for seamless and secure updates to the gateway firmware through the iControl Maintenance Application on the server 104, providing a transparent, hassle-free mechanism for the service provider to deploy new features and bug fixes to the installed user base. The firmware download mechanism is tolerant of connection loss, power interruption and user interventions (both intentional and unintentional). Such robustness reduces down time and customer support issues. Touchscreen firmware can be remotely download either for one touchscreen at a time, a group of touchscreen, or in batches.

The Automations engine 308 of the touchscreen manages the user-defined rules of interaction between the different devices (e.g. when door opens turn on the light). Though the automation rules are programmed and reside at the portal/server level, they are cached at the gateway level in order to provide short latency between device triggers and actions.

DeviceConnect 310 of the touchscreen touchscreen includes definitions of all supported devices (e.g., cameras, security panels, sensors, etc.) using a standardized plug-in architecture. The DeviceConnect module 310 offers an interface that can be used to quickly add support for any new device as well as enabling interoperability between devices that use different technologies/protocols. For common device types, pre-defined sub-modules have been defined, making supporting new devices of these types even easier. SensorConnect 312 is provided for adding new sensors, CameraConnect 316 for adding IP cameras, and PanelConnect 314 for adding home security panels.

The Schedules engine 318 of the touchscreen is responsible for executing the user defined schedules (e.g., take a picture every five minutes; every day at 8 am set temperature to 65 degrees Fahrenheit, etc.). Though the schedules are programmed and reside at the iConnect server level they are sent to the scheduler within the gateway application of the touchscreen. The Schedules Engine 318 then interfaces with SensorConnect 312 to ensure that scheduled events occur at precisely the desired time.

The Device Management module 320 of the touchscreen is in charge of all discovery, installation and configuration of both wired and wireless IP devices (e.g., cameras, etc.) coupled or connected to the system. Networked IP devices, such as those used in the integrated security system, require user configuration of many IP and security parameters, and the device management module of an embodiment handles the details of this configuration. The device management module also manages the video routing module described below.

The video routing engine 322 of the touchscreen is responsible for delivering seamless video streams to the user with zero-configuration. Through a multi-step, staged approach the video routing engine uses a combination of UPnP port-forwarding, relay server routing and STUN/TURN peer-to-peer routing. The video routing engine is described in detail in the Related Applications.

FIG. 9 is a block diagram 900 of network or premise device integration with a premise network 250, under an embodiment. In an embodiment, network devices 255, 256, 957 are coupled to the touchscreen 902 using a secure network connection such as SSL over an encrypted 802.11 link (utilizing for example WPA-2 security for the wireless encryption), and the touchscreen 902 coupled to the premise router/firewall 252 via a coupling with a premise LAN 250. The premise router/firewall 252 is coupled to a broadband modem 251, and the broadband modem 251 is coupled to a WAN 200 or other network outside the premise. The touchscreen 902 thus enables or forms a separate wireless network, or sub-network, that includes some number of devices and is coupled or connected to the LAN 250 of the host premises. The touchscreen sub-network can include, but is not limited to, any number of other devices like WiFi IP cameras, security panels (e.g., IP-enabled), and IP devices, to name a few. The touchscreen 902 manages or controls the sub-network separately from the LAN 250 and transfers data and information between components of the sub-network and the LAN 250/WAN 200, but is not so limited. Additionally, other network devices 254 can be coupled to the LAN 250 without being coupled to the touchscreen 902.

FIG. 10 is a block diagram 1000 of network or premise device integration with a premise network 250, under an alternative embodiment. The network or premise devices 255, 256, 1057 are coupled to the touchscreen 1002, and the touchscreen 1002 is coupled or connected between the premise router/firewall 252 and the broadband modem 251. The broadband modem 251 is coupled to a WAN 200 or other network outside the premise, while the premise router/firewall 252 is coupled to a premise LAN 250. As a result of its location between the broadband modem 251 and the premise router/firewall 252, the touchscreen 1002 can be configured or function as the premise router routing specified data between the outside network (e.g., WAN 200) and the premise router/firewall 252 of the LAN 250. As described above, the touchscreen 1002 in this configuration enables or forms a separate wireless network, or sub-network, that includes the network or premise devices 255, 156, 1057 and is coupled or connected between the LAN 250 of the host premises and the WAN 200. The touchscreen sub-network can include, but is not limited to, any number of network or premise devices 255, 256, 1057 like WiFi IP cameras, security panels (e.g., IP-enabled), and security touchscreens, to name a few. The touchscreen 1002 manages or controls the sub-network separately from the LAN 250 and transfers data and information between components of the sub-network and the LAN 250/WAN 200, but is not so limited. Additionally, other network devices 254 can be coupled to the LAN 250 without being coupled to the touchscreen 1002.

The gateway of an embodiment, whether a stand-along component or integrated with a touchscreen, enables couplings or connections and thus the flow or integration of information between various components of the host premises and various types and/or combinations of IP devices, where the components of the host premises include a network (e.g., LAN) and/or a security system or subsystem to name a few. Consequently, the gateway controls the association between and the flow of information or data between the components of the host premises. For example, the gateway of an embodiment forms a sub-network coupled to another network (e.g., WAN, LAN, etc.), with the sub-network including IP devices. The gateway further enables the association of the IP devices of the sub-network with appropriate systems on the premises (e.g., security system, etc.). Therefore, for example, the gateway can form a sub-network of IP devices configured for security functions, and associate the sub-network only with the premises security system, thereby segregating the IP devices dedicated to security from other IP devices that may be coupled to another network on the premises.

The gateway of an embodiment, as described herein, enables couplings or connections and thus the flow of information between various components of the host premises and various types and/or combinations of IP devices, where the components of the host premises include a network, a security system or subsystem to name a few. Consequently, the gateway controls the association between and the flow of information or data between the components of the host premises. For example, the gateway of an embodiment forms a sub-network coupled to another network (e.g., WAN, LAN, etc.), with the sub-network including IP devices. The gateway further enables the association of the IP devices of the sub-network with appropriate systems on the premises (e.g., security system, etc.). Therefore, for example, the gateway can form a sub-network of IP devices configured for security functions, and associate the sub-network only with the premises security system, thereby segregating the IP devices dedicated to security from other IP devices that may be coupled to another network on the premises.

FIG. 11 is a flow diagram for a method 1100 of forming a security network including integrated security system components, under an embodiment. Generally, the method comprises coupling 1102 a gateway comprising a connection management component to a local area network in a first location and a security server in a second location. The method comprises forming 1104 a security network by automatically establishing a wireless coupling between the gateway and a security system using the connection management component. The security system of an embodiment comprises security system components located at the first location. The method comprises integrating 1106 communications and functions of the security system components into the security network via the wireless coupling.

FIG. 12 is a flow diagram for a method 1200 of forming a security network including integrated security system components and network devices, under an embodiment. Generally, the method comprises coupling 1202 a gateway to a local area network located in a first location and a security server in a second location. The method comprises automatically establishing 1204 communications between the gateway and security system components at the first location, the security system including the security system components. The method comprises automatically establishing 1206 communications between the gateway and premise devices at the first location. The method comprises forming 1208 a security network by electronically integrating, via the gateway, communications and functions of the premise devices and the security system components.

In an example embodiment, FIG. 13 is a flow diagram 1300 for integration or installation of an IP device into a private network environment, under an embodiment. The IP device includes any IP-capable device that, for example, includes the touchscreen of an embodiment. The variables of an embodiment set at time of installation include, but are not limited to, one or more of a private SSID/Password, a gateway identifier, a security panel identifier, a user account TS, and a Central Monitoring Station account identification.

An embodiment of the IP device discovery and management begins with a user or installer activating 1302 the gateway and initiating 1304 the install mode of the system. This places the gateway in an install mode. Once in install mode, the gateway shifts to a default (Install) Wifi configuration. This setting will match the default setting for other integrated security system-enabled devices that have been pre-configured to work with the integrated security system. The gateway will then begin to provide 1306 DHCP addresses for these IP devices. Once the devices have acquired a new DHCP address from the gateway, those devices are available for configuration into a new secured Wifi network setting.

The user or installer of the system selects 1308 all devices that have been identified as available for inclusion into the integrated security system. The user may select these devices by their unique IDs via a web page, Touchscreen, or other client interface. The gateway provides 1310 data as appropriate to the devices. Once selected, the devices are configured 1312 with appropriate secured Wifi settings, including SSID and WPA/WPA-2 keys that are used once the gateway switches back to the secured sandbox configuration from the “Install” settings. Other settings are also configured as appropriate for that type of device. Once all devices have been configured, the user is notified and the user can exit install mode. At this point all devices will have been registered 1314 with the integrated security system servers.

The installer switches 1316 the gateway to an operational mode, and the gateway instructs or directs 1318 all newly configured devices to switch to the “secured” Wifi sandbox settings. The gateway then switches 1320 to the “secured” Wifi settings. Once the devices identify that the gateway is active on the “secured” network, they request new DHCP addresses from the gateway which, in response, provides 1322 the new addresses. The devices with the new addresses are then operational 1324 on the secured network.

In order to ensure the highest level of security on the secured network, the gateway can create or generate a dynamic network security configuration based on the unique ID and private key in the gateway, coupled with a randomizing factor that can be based on online time or other inputs. This guarantees the uniqueness of the gateway secured network configuration.

To enable the highest level of performance, the gateway analyzes the RF spectrum of the 802.11x network and determines which frequency band/channel it should select to run.

An alternative embodiment of the camera/IP device management process leverages the local ethernet connection of the sandbox network on the gateway. This alternative process is similar to the Wifi discovery embodiment described above, except the user connects the targeted device to the ethernet port of the sandbox network to begin the process. This alternative embodiment accommodates devices that have not been pre-configured with the default “Install” configuration for the integrated security system.

This alternative embodiment of the IP device discovery and management begins with the user/installer placing the system into install mode. The user is instructed to attach an IP device to be installed to the sandbox Ethernet port of the gateway. The IP device requests a DHCP address from the gateway which, in response to the request, provides the address. The user is presented the device and is asked if he/she wants to install the device. If yes, the system configures the device with the secured Wifi settings and other device-specific settings (e.g., camera settings for video length, image quality etc.). The user is next instructed to disconnect the device from the ethernet port. The device is now available for use on the secured sandbox network.

FIG. 14 is a block diagram showing communications among integrated IP devices of the private network environment, under an embodiment. The IP devices of this example include a security touchscreen 1403, gateway 1402 (e.g., “iHub”), and security panel (e.g., “Security Panel 1”, “Security Panel 2”, “Security Panel n”), but the embodiment is not so limited. In alternative embodiments any number and/or combination of these three primary component types may be combined with other components including IP devices and/or security system components. For example, a single device that comprises an integrated gateway, touchscreen, and security panel is merely another embodiment of the integrated security system described herein. The description that follows includes an example configuration that includes a touchscreen hosting particular applications. However, the embodiment is not limited to the touchscreen hosting these applications, and the touchscreen should be thought of as representing any IP device.

Referring to FIG. 14 , the touchscreen 1403 incorporates an application 1410 that is implemented as computer code resident on the touchscreen operating system, or as a web-based application running in a browser, or as another type of scripted application (e.g., Flash, Java, Visual Basic, etc.). The touchscreen core application 1410 represents this application, providing user interface and logic for the end user to manage their security system or to gain access to networked information or content (Widgets). The touchscreen core application 1410 in turn accesses a library or libraries of functions to control the local hardware (e.g. screen display, sound, LEDs, memory, etc.) as well as specialized librarie(s) to couple or connect to the security system.

In an embodiment of this security system connection, the touchscreen 1403 communicates to the gateway 1402, and has no direct communication with the security panel. In this embodiment, the touchscreen core application 1410 accesses the remote service APIs 1412 which provide security system functionality (e.g. ARM/DISARM panel, sensor state, get/set panel configuration parameters, initiate or get alarm events, etc.). In an embodiment, the remote service APIs 1412 implement one or more of the following functions, but the embodiment is not so limited: Armstate=setARMState(type=“ARM STAY|ARM AWAY|DISARM”, Parameters=“ExitDelay=30|Lights=OFF”); sensorState=getSensors(type=“ALL|SensorName|SensorNameList”); result=setSensorState(SensorName, parameters=“Option1, Options2, . . . Option n”); interruptHandler=SensorEvent( ); and, interruptHandler=alarmEvent( ).

Functions of the remote service APIs 1412 of an embodiment use a remote PanelConnect API 1424 which which resides in memory on the gateway 1402. The touchscreen 1403 communicates with the gateway 1402 through a suitable network interface such as an Ethernet or 802.11 RF connection, for example. The remote PanelConnect API 1424 provides the underlying Security System Interfaces 1426 used to communicate with and control one or more types of security panel via wired link 1430 and/or RF link 3. The PanelConnect API 1224 provides responses and input to the remote services APIs 1426, and in turn translates function calls and data to and from the specific protocols and functions supported by a specific implementation of a Security Panel (e.g. a GE Security Simon XT or Honeywell Vista 20P). In an embodiment, the PanelConnect API 1224 uses a 345 MHz RF transceiver or receiver hardware/firmware module to communicate wirelessly to the security panel and directly to a set of 345 MHz RF-enabled sensors and devices, but the embodiment is not so limited.

The gateway of an alternative embodiment communicates over a wired physical coupling or connection to the security panel using the panel's specific wired hardware (bus) interface and the panel's bus-level protocol.

In an alternative embodiment, the Touchscreen 1403 implements the same PanelConnect API 1414 locally on the Touchscreen 1403, communicating directly with the Security Panel 2 and/or Sensors 2 over the proprietary RF link or over a wired link for that system. In this embodiment the Touchscreen 1403, instead of the gateway 1402, incorporates the 345 MHz RF transceiver to communicate directly with Security Panel 2 or Sensors 2 over the RF link 2. In the case of a wired link the Touchscreen 1403 incorporates the real-time hardware (e.g. a PIC chip and RS232-variant serial link) to physically connect to and satisfy the specific bus-level timing requirements of the SecurityPanel2.

In yet another alternative embodiment, either the gateway 1402 or the Touchscreen 1403 implements the remote service APIs. This embodiment includes a Cricket device (“Cricket”) which comprises but is not limited to the following components: a processor (suitable for handling 802.11 protocols and processing, as well as the bus timing requirements of SecurityPanel1); an 802.11 (WiFi) client IP interface chip; and, a serial bus interface chip that implements variants of RS232 or RS485, depending on the specific Security Panel.

The Cricket also implements the full PanelConnect APIs such that it can perform the same functions as the case where the gateway implements the PanelConnect APIs. In this embodiment, the touchscreen core application 1410 calls functions in the remote service APIs 1412 (such as setArmState( )). These functions in turn couple or connect to the remote Cricket through a standard IP connection (“Cricket IP Link”) (e.g., Ethernet, Homeplug, the gateway's proprietary Wifi network, etc.). The Cricket in turn implements the PanelConnect API, which responds to the request from the touchscreen core application, and performs the appropriate function using the proprietary panel interface. This interface uses either the wireless or wired proprietary protocol for the specific security panel and/or sensors.

FIG. 15 is a flow diagram of a method of integrating an external control and management application system with an existing security system, under an embodiment. Operations begin when the system is powered on 1510, involving at a minimum the power-on of the gateway device, and optionally the power-on of the connection between the gateway device and the remote servers. The gateway device initiates 1520 a software and RF sequence to locate the extant security system. The gateway and installer initiate and complete 1530 a sequence to ‘learn’ the gateway into the security system as a valid and authorized control device. The gateway initiates 1540 another software and RF sequence of instructions to discover and learn the existence and capabilities of existing RF devices within the extant security system, and store this information in the system. These operations under the system of an embodiment are described in further detail below.

Unlike conventional systems that extend an existing security system, the system of an embodiment operates utilizing the proprietary wireless protocols of the security system manufacturer. In one illustrative embodiment, the gateway is an embedded computer with an IP LAN and WAN connection and a plurality of RF transceivers and software protocol modules capable of communicating with a plurality of security systems each with a potentially different RF and software protocol interface. After the gateway has completed the discovery and learning 1540 of sensors and has been integrated 1550 as a virtual control device in the extant security system, the system becomes operational. Thus, the security system and associated sensors are presented 1550 as accessible devices to a potential plurality of user interface subsystems.

The system of an embodiment integrates 1560 the functionality of the extant security system with other non-security devices including but not limited to IP cameras, touchscreens, lighting controls, door locking mechanisms, which may be controlled via RF, wired, or powerline-based networking mechanisms supported by the gateway or servers.

The system of an embodiment provides a user interface subsystem 1570 enabling a user to monitor, manage, and control the system and associated sensors and security systems. In an embodiment of the system, a user interface subsystem is an HTML/XML/Javascript/Java/AJAX/Flash presentation of a monitoring and control application, enabling users to view the state of all sensors and controllers in the extant security system from a web browser or equivalent operating on a computer, PDA, mobile phone, or other consumer device.

In another illustrative embodiment of the system described herein, a user interface subsystem is an HTML/XML/Javascript/Java/AJAX presentation of a monitoring and control application, enabling users to combine the monitoring and control of the extant security system and sensors with the monitoring and control of non-security devices including but not limited to IP cameras, touchscreens, lighting controls, door locking mechanisms.

In another illustrative embodiment of the system described herein, a user interface subsystem is a mobile phone application enabling users to monitor and control the extant security system as well as other non-security devices.

In another illustrative embodiment of the system described herein, a user interface subsystem is an application running on a keypad or touchscreen device enabling users to monitor and control the extant security system as well as other non-security devices.

In another illustrative embodiment of the system described herein, a user interface subsystem is an application operating on a TV or set-top box connected to a TV enabling users to monitor and control the extant security system as well as other non-security devices.

FIG. 16 is a block diagram of an integrated security system 1600 wirelessly interfacing to proprietary security systems, under an embodiment. A security system 1610 is coupled or connected to a Gateway 1620, and from Gateway 1620 coupled or connected to a plurality of information and content sources across a network 1630 including one or more web servers 1640, system databases 1650, and applications servers 1660. While in one embodiment network 1630 is the Internet, including the World Wide Web, those of skill in the art will appreciate that network 1630 may be any type of network, such as an intranet, an extranet, a virtual private network (VPN), a mobile network, or a non-TCP/IP based network.

Moreover, other elements of the system of an embodiment may be conventional, well-known elements that need not be explained in detail herein. For example, security system 1610 could be any type home or business security system, such devices including but not limited to a standalone RF home security system or a non-RF-capable wired home security system with an add-on RF interface module. In the integrated security system 1600 of this example, security system 1610 includes an RF-capable wireless security panel (WSP) 1611 that acts as the master controller for security system 1610. Well-known examples of such a WSP include the GE Security Concord, Networx, and Simon panels, the Honeywell Vista and Lynx panels, and similar panels from DSC and Napco, to name a few. A wireless module 1614 includes the RF hardware and protocol software necessary to enable communication with and control of a plurality of wireless devices 1613. WSP 1611 may also manage wired devices 1614 physically connected to WSP 1611 with an RS232 or RS485 or Ethernet connection or similar such wired interface.

In an implementation consistent with the systems and methods described herein, Gateway 1620 provides the interface between security system 1610 and LAN and/or WAN for purposes of remote control, monitoring, and management. Gateway 1620 communicates with an external web server 1640, database 1650, and application server 1660 over network 1630 (which may comprise WAN, LAN, or a combination thereof). In this example system, application logic, remote user interface functionality, as well as user state and account are managed by the combination of these remote servers. Gateway 1620 includes server connection manager 1621, a software interface module responsible for all server communication over network 1630. Event manager 1622 implements the main event loop for Gateway 1620, processing events received from device manager 1624 (communicating with non-security system devices including but not limited to IP cameras, wireless thermostats, or remote door locks). Event manager 1622 further processes events and control messages from and to security system 1610 by utilizing WSP manager 1623.

WSP manager 1623 and device manager 1624 both rely upon wireless protocol manager 1626 which receives and stores the proprietary or standards-based protocols required to support security system 1610 as well as any other devices interfacing with gateway 1620. WSP manager 1623 further utilizes the comprehensive protocols and interface algorithms for a plurality of security systems 1610 stored in the WSP DB client database associated with wireless protocol manager 1626. These various components implement the software logic and protocols necessary to communicate with and manager devices and security systems 1610. Wireless Transceiver hardware modules 1625 are then used to implement the physical RF communications link to such devices and security systems 1610. An illustrative wireless transceiver 1625 is the GE Security Dialog circuit board, implementing a 319.5 MHz two-way RF transceiver module. In this example, RF Link 1670 represents the 319.5 MHz RF communication link, enabling gateway 1620 to monitor and control WSP 1611 and associated wireless and wired devices 1613 and 1614, respectively.

In one embodiment, server connection manager 1621 requests and receives a set of wireless protocols for a specific security system 1610 (an illustrative example being that of the GE Security Concord panel and sensors) and stores them in the WSP DB portion of the wireless protocol manager 1626. WSP manager 1623 then utilizes such protocols from wireless protocol manager 1626 to initiate the sequence of processes detailed in FIG. 15 and FIG. 16 for learning gateway 1620 into security system 1610 as an authorized control device. Once learned in, as described with reference to FIG. 16 (and above), event manager 1622 processes all events and messages detected by the combination of WSP manager 1623 and the GE Security wireless transceiver module 1625.

In another embodiment, gateway 1620 incorporates a plurality of wireless transceivers 1625 and associated protocols managed by wireless protocol manager 1626. In this embodiment events and control of multiple heterogeneous devices may be coordinated with WSP 1611, wireless devices 1613, and wired devices 1614. For example a wireless sensor from one manufacturer may be utilized to control a device using a different protocol from a different manufacturer.

In another embodiment, gateway 1620 incorporates a wired interface to security system 1610, and incorporates a plurality of wireless transceivers 1625 and associated protocols managed by wireless protocol manager 1626. In this embodiment events and control of multiple heterogeneous devices may be coordinated with WSP 1611, wireless devices 1613, and wired devices 1614.

Of course, while an illustrative embodiment of an architecture of the system of an embodiment is described in detail herein with respect to FIG. 16 , one of skill in the art will understand that modifications to this architecture may be made without departing from the scope of the description presented herein. For example, the functionality described herein may be allocated differently between client and server, or amongst different server or processor-based components. Likewise, the entire functionality of the gateway 1620 described herein could be integrated completely within an existing security system 1610. In such an embodiment, the architecture could be directly integrated with a security system 1610 in a manner consistent with the currently described embodiments.

FIG. 17 is a flow diagram for wirelessly ‘learning’ the Gateway into an existing security system and discovering extant sensors, under an embodiment. The learning interfaces gateway 1620 with security system 1610. Gateway 1620 powers up 1710 and initiates software sequences 1720 and 1725 to identify accessible WSPs 1611 and wireless devices 1613, respectively (e.g., one or more WSPs and/or devices within range of gateway 1620). Once identified, WSP 1611 is manually or automatically set into ‘learn mode’ 1730, and gateway 1620 utilizes available protocols to add 1740 itself as an authorized control device in security system 1610. Upon successful completion of this task, WSP 1611 is manually or automatically removed from ‘learn mode’ 1750.

Gateway 1620 utilizes the appropriate protocols to mimic 1760 the first identified device 1614. In this operation gateway 1620 identifies itself using the unique or pseudo-unique identifier of the first found device 1614, and sends an appropriate change of state message over RF Link 1670. In the event that WSP 1611 responds to this change of state message, the device 1614 is then added 1770 to the system in database 1650. Gateway 1620 associates 1780 any other information (such as zone name or token-based identifier) with this device 1614 in database 1650, enabling gateway 1620, user interface modules, or any application to retrieve this associated information.

In the event that WSP 1611 does not respond to the change of state message, the device 1614 is not added 1770 to the system in database 1650, and this device 1614 is identified as not being a part of security system 1610 with a flag, and is either ignored or added as an independent device, at the discretion of the system provisioning rules. Operations hereunder repeat 1785 operations 1760, 1770, 1780 for all devices 1614 if applicable. Once all devices 1614 have been tested in this way, the system begins operation 1790.

In another embodiment, gateway 1620 utilizes a wired connection to WSP 1611, but also incorporates a wireless transceiver 1625 to communicate directly with devices 1614. In this embodiment, operations under 1720 above are removed, and operations under 1740 above are modified so the system of this embodiment utilizes wireline protocols to add itself as an authorized control device in security system 1610.

A description of an example embodiment follows in which the Gateway (FIG. 16 , element 1620) is the iHub available from iControl Networks, Palo Alto, Calif., and described in detail herein. In this example the gateway is “automatically” installed with a security system.

The automatic security system installation begins with the assignment of an authorization key to components of the security system (e.g., gateway, kit including the gateway, etc.). The assignment of an authorization key is done in lieu of creating a user account. An installer later places the gateway in a user's premises along with the premises security system. The installer uses a computer to navigate to a web portal (e.g., integrated security system web interface), logs in to the portal, and enters the authorization key of the installed gateway into the web portal for authentication. Once authenticated, the gateway automatically discovers devices at the premises (e.g., sensors, cameras, light controls, etc.) and adds the discovered devices to the system or “network”. The installer assigns names to the devices, and tests operation of the devices back to the server (e.g., did the door open, did the camera take a picture, etc.). The security device information is optionally pushed or otherwise propagated to a security panel and/or to the server network database. The installer finishes the installation, and instructs the end user on how to create an account, username, and password. At this time the user enters the authorization key which validates the account creation (uses a valid authorization key to associate the network with the user's account).New devices may subsequently be added to the security network in a variety of ways (e.g., user first enters a unique ID for each device/sensor and names it in the server, after which the gateway can automatically discover and configure the device).

A description of another example embodiment follows in which the security system (FIG. 16 , element 1610) is a Dialog system and the WSP (FIG. 16 , element 1611) is a SimonXT available from General Electric Security, and the Gateway (FIG. 16 , element 1620) is the iHub available from iControl Networks, Palo Alto, Calif., and described in detail herein. Descriptions of the install process for the SimonXT and iHub are also provided below.

GE Security's Dialog network is one of the most widely deployed and tested wireless security systems in the world. The physical RF network is based on a 319.5 MHz unlicensed spectrum, with a bandwidth supporting up to 19 Kbps communications. Typical use of this bandwidth—even in conjunction with the integrated security system—is far less than that. Devices on this network can support either one-way communication (either a transmitter or a receiver) or two-way communication (a transceiver). Certain GE Simon, Simon XT, and Concord security control panels incorporate a two-way transceiver as a standard component. The gateway also incorporates the same two-way transceiver card. The physical link layer of the network is managed by the transceiver module hardware and firmware, while the coded payload bitstreams are made available to the application layer for processing.

Sensors in the Dialog network typically use a 60-bit protocol for communicating with the security panel transceiver, while security system keypads and the gateway use the encrypted 80-bit protocol. The Dialog network is configured for reliability, as well as low-power usage. Many devices are supervised, i.e. they are regularly monitored by the system ‘master’ (typically a GE security panel), while still maintaining excellent power usage characteristics. A typical door window sensor has a battery life in excess of 5-7 years.

The gateway has two modes of operation in the Dialog network: a first mode of operation is when the gateway is configured or operates as a ‘slave’ to the GE security panel; a second mode of operation is when the gateway is configured or operates as a ‘master’ to the system in the event a security panel is not present. In both configurations, the gateway has the ability to ‘listen’ to network traffic, enabling the gateway to continually keep track of the status of all devices in the system. Similarly, in both situations the gateway can address and control devices that support setting adjustments (such as the GE wireless thermostat).

In the configuration in which the gateway acts as a ‘slave’ to the security panel, the gateway is ‘learned into’ the system as a GE wireless keypad. In this mode of operation, the gateway emulates a security system keypad when managing the security panel, and can query the security panel for status and ‘listen’ to security panel events (such as alarm events).

The gateway incorporates an RF Transceiver manufactured by GE Security, but is not so limited. This transceiver implements the Dialog protocols and handles all network message transmissions, receptions, and timing. As such, the physical, link, and protocol layers of the communications between the gateway and any GE device in the Dialog network are totally compliant with GE Security specifications.

At the application level, the gateway emulates the behavior of a GE wireless keypad utilizing the GE Security 80-bit encrypted protocol, and only supported protocols and network traffic are generated by the gateway. Extensions to the Dialog RF protocol of an embodiment enable full control and configuration of the panel, and iControl can both automate installation and sensor enrollment as well as direct configuration downloads for the panel under these protocol extensions.

As described above, the gateway participates in the GE Security network at the customer premises. Because the gateway has intelligence and a two-way transceiver, it can ‘hear’ all of the traffic on that network. The gateway makes use of the periodic sensor updates, state changes, and supervisory signals of the network to maintain a current state of the premises. This data is relayed to the integrated security system server (e.g., FIG. 2 , element 260) and stored in the event repository for use by other server components. This usage of the GE Security RF network is completely non-invasive; there is no new data traffic created to support this activity.

The gateway can directly (or indirectly through the Simon XT panel) control two-way devices on the network. For example, the gateway can direct a GE Security Thermostat to change its setting to ‘Cool’ from ‘Off’, as well as request an update on the current temperature of the room. The gateway performs these functions using the existing GE Dialog protocols, with little to no impact on the network; a gateway device control or data request takes only a few dozen bytes of data in a network that can support 19 Kbps.

By enrolling with the Simon XT as a wireless keypad, as described herein, the gateway includes data or information of all alarm events, as well as state changes relevant to the security panel. This information is transferred to the gateway as encrypted packets in the same way that the information is transferred to all other wireless keypads on the network.

Because of its status as an authorized keypad, the gateway can also initiate the same panel commands that a keypad can initiate. For example, the gateway can arm or disarm the panel using the standard Dialog protocol for this activity. Other than the monitoring of standard alarm events like other network keypads, the only incremental data traffic on the network as a result of the gateway is the infrequent remote arm/disarm events that the gateway initiates, or infrequent queries on the state of the panel.

The gateway is enrolled into the Simon XT panel as a ‘slave’ device which, in an embodiment, is a wireless keypad. This enables the gateway for all necessary functionality for operating the Simon XT system remotely, as well as combining the actions and information of non-security devices such as lighting or door locks with GE Security devices. The only resource taken up by the gateway in this scenario is one wireless zone (sensor ID).

The gateway of an embodiment supports three forms of sensor and panel enrollment/installation into the integrated security system, but is not limited to this number of enrollment/installation options. The enrollment/installation options of an embodiment include installer installation, kitting, and panel, each of which is described below.

Under the installer option, the installer enters the sensor IDs at time of installation into the integrated security system web portal or iScreen. This technique is supported in all configurations and installations.

Kits can be pre-provisioned using integrated security system provisioning applications when using the kitting option. At kitting time, multiple sensors are automatically associated with an account, and at install time there is no additional work required.

In the case where a panel is installed with sensors already enrolled (i.e. using the GE Simon XT enrollment process), the gateway has the capability to automatically extract the sensor information from the system and incorporate it into the user account on the integrated security system server.

The gateway and integrated security system of an embodiment uses an auto-learn process for sensor and panel enrollment in an embodiment. The deployment approach of an embodiment can use additional interfaces that GE Security is adding to the Simon XT panel. With these interfaces, the gateway has the capability to remotely enroll sensors in the panel automatically. The interfaces include, but are not limited to, the following: EnrollDevice(ID, type, name, zone, group); SetDeviceParameters(ID, type, Name, zone, group), GetDeviceParameters(zone); and RemoveDevice(zone).

The integrated security system incorporates these new interfaces into the system, providing the following install process. The install process can include integrated security system logistics to handle kitting and pre-provisioning. Pre-kitting and logistics can include a pre-provisioning kitting tool provided by integrated security system that enables a security system vendor or provider (“provider”) to offer pre-packaged initial ‘kits’. This is not required but is recommended for simplifying the install process. This example assumes a ‘Basic’ kit is preassembled and includes one (1) Simon XT, three (3) Door/window sensors, one (1) motion sensor, one (1) gateway, one (1) keyfob, two (2) cameras, and ethernet cables. The kit also includes a sticker page with all Zones (1-24) and Names (full name list).

The provider uses the integrated security system kitting tool to assemble ‘Basic’ kit packages. The contents of different types of starter kits may be defined by the provider. At the distribution warehouse, a worker uses a bar code scanner to scan each sensor and the gateway as it is packed into the box. An ID label is created that is attached to the box. The scanning process automatically associates all the devices with one kit, and the new ID label is the unique identifier of the kit. These boxes are then sent to the provider for distribution to installer warehouses. Individual sensors, cameras, etc. are also sent to the provider installer warehouse. Each is labeled with its own barcode/ID.

An installation and enrollment procedure of a security system including a gateway is described below as one example of the installation process.

1. Order and Physical Install Process

a. Once an order is generated in the iControl system, an account is created and an install ticket is created and sent electronically to the provider for assignment to an installer.

b. The assigned installer picks up his/her ticket(s) and fills his/her truck with Basic and/or Advanced starter kits. He/she also keeps a stock of individual sensors, cameras, iHubs, Simon XTs, etc. Optionally, the installer can also stock homeplug adapters for problematic installations.

c. The installer arrives at the address on the ticket, and pulls out the Basic kit. The installer determines sensor locations from a tour of the premises and discussion with the homeowner. At this point assume the homeowner requests additional equipment including an extra camera, two (2) additional door/window sensors, one (1) glass break detector, and one (1) smoke detector.

d. Installer mounts SimonXT in the kitchen or other location in the home as directed by the homeowner, and routes the phone line to Simon XT if available. GPRS and Phone numbers pre-programmed in SimonXT to point to the provider Central Monitoring Station (CMS).

e. Installer places gateway in the home in the vicinity of a router and cable modem. Installer installs an ethernet line from gateway to router and plugs gateway into an electrical outlet.

2. Associate and Enroll gateway into SimonXT

a. Installer uses either his/her own laptop plugged into router, or homeowners computer to go to the integrated security system web interface and log in with installer ID/pass.

b. Installer enters ticket number into admin interface, and clicks ‘New Install’ button. Screen prompts installer for kit ID (on box's barcode label).

c. Installer clicks ‘Add SimonXT’. Instructions prompt installer to put Simon XT into install mode, and add gateway as a wireless keypad. It is noted that this step is for security only and can be automated in an embodiment.

d. Installer enters the installer code into the Simon XT. Installer Learns ‘gateway’ into the panel as a wireless keypad as a group 1 device.

e. Installer goes back to Web portal, and clicks the ‘Finished Adding SimonXT’ button.

3. Enroll Sensors into SimonXT via iControl

a. All devices in the Basic kit are already associated with the user's account.

b. For additional devices, Installer clicks ‘Add Device’ and adds the additional camera to the user's account (by typing in the camera ID/Serial #).

c. Installer clicks ‘Add Device’ and adds other sensors (two (2) door/window sensors, one (1) glass break sensor, and one (1) smoke sensor) to the account (e.g., by typing in IDs).

d. As part of Add Device, Installer assigns zone, name, and group to the sensor. Installer puts appropriate Zone and Name sticker on the sensor temporarily.

e. All sensor information for the account is pushed or otherwise propagated to the iConnect server, and is available to propagate to CMS automation software through the CMS application programming interface (API).

f. Web interface displays ‘Installing Sensors in System . . . ’ and automatically adds all of the sensors to the Simon XT panel through the GE RF link.

g. Web interface displays ‘Done Installing’→all sensors show green.

4. Place and Tests Sensors in Home

a. Installer physically mounts each sensor in its desired location, and removes the stickers.

b. Installer physically mounts WiFi cameras in their location and plugs into AC power. Optional fishing of low voltage wire through wall to remove dangling wires. Camera transformer is still plugged into outlet but wire is now inside the wall.

c. Installer goes to Web interface and is prompted for automatic camera install. Each camera is provisioned as a private, encrypted Wifi device on the gateway secured sandbox network, and firewall NAT traversal is initiated. Upon completion the customer is prompted to test the security system.

d. Installer selects the ‘Test System’ button on the web portal—the SimonXT is put into Test mode by the gateway over GE RF.

e. Installer manually tests the operation of each sensor, receiving an audible confirmation from SimonXT.

f. gateway sends test data directly to CMS over broadband link, as well as storing the test data in the user's account for subsequent report generation.

g. Installer exits test mode from the Web portal.

5. Installer instructs customer on use of the Simon XT, and shows customer how to log into the iControl web and mobile portals. Customer creates a username/password at this time.

6. Installer instructs customer how to change Simon XT user code from the Web interface. Customer changes user code which is pushed to SimonXT automatically over GE RF.

An installation and enrollment procedure of a security system including a gateway is described below as an alternative example of the installation process. This installation process is for use for enrolling sensors into the SimonXT and integrated security system and is compatible with all existing GE Simon panels.

The integrated security system supports all pre-kitting functionality described in the installation process above. However, for the purpose of the following example, no kitting is used.

1. Order and Physical Install Process

a. Once an order is generated in the iControl system, an account is created and an install ticket is created and sent electronically to the security system provider for assignment to an installer.

b. The assigned installer picks up his/her ticket(s) and fills his/her truck with individual sensors, cameras, iHubs, Simon XTs, etc. Optionally, the installer can also stock homeplug adapters for problematic installations.

c. The installer arrives at the address on the ticket, and analyzes the house and talks with the homeowner to determine sensor locations. At this point assume the homeowner requests three (3) cameras, five (5) door/window sensors, one (1) glass break detector, one (1) smoke detector, and one (1) keyfob.

d. Installer mounts SimonXT in the kitchen or other location in the home. The installer routes a phone line to Simon XT if available. GPRS and Phone numbers are pre-programmed in SimonXT to point to the provider CMS.

e. Installer places gateway in home in the vicinity of a router and cable modem, and installs an ethernet line from gateway to the router, and plugs gateway into an electrical outlet.

2. Associate and Enroll gateway into SimonXT

a. Installer uses either his/her own laptop plugged into router, or homeowners computer to go to the integrated security system web interface and log in with an installer ID/pass.

b. Installer enters ticket number into admin interface, and clicks ‘New Install’ button. Screen prompts installer to add devices.

c. Installer types in ID of gateway, and it is associated with the user's account.

d. Installer clicks ‘Add Device’ and adds the cameras to the user's account (by typing in the camera ID/Serial #).

e. Installer clicks ‘Add SimonXT’. Instructions prompt installer to put Simon XT into install mode, and add gateway as a wireless keypad.

f. Installer goes to Simon XT and enters the installer code into the Simon XT. Learns ‘gateway’ into the panel as a wireless keypad as group 1 type sensor.

g. Installer returns to Web portal, and clicks the ‘Finished Adding SimonXT’ button.

h. Gateway now is alerted to all subsequent installs over the security system RF.

3. Enroll Sensors into SimonXT via iControl

a. Installer clicks ‘Add Simon XT Sensors’—Displays instructions for adding sensors to Simon XT.

b. Installer goes to Simon XT and uses Simon XT install process to add each sensor, assigning zone, name, group. These assignments are recorded for later use.

c. The gateway automatically detects each sensor addition and adds the new sensor to the integrated security system.

d. Installer exits install mode on the Simon XT, and returns to the Web portal.

e. Installer clicks ‘Done Adding Devices’.

f. Installer enters zone/sensor naming from recorded notes into integrated security system to associate sensors to friendly names.

g. All sensor information for the account is pushed to the iConnect server, and is available to propagate to CMS automation software through the CMS API.

4. Place and Tests Sensors in Home

a. Installer physically mounts each sensor in its desired location.

b. Installer physically mounts Wifi cameras in their location and plugs into AC power. Optional fishing of low voltage wire through wall to remove dangling wires. Camera transformer is still plugged into outlet but wire is now inside the wall.

c. Installer puts SimonXT into Test mode from the keypad.

d. Installer manually tests the operation of each sensor, receiving an audible confirmation from SimonXT.

e. Installer exits test mode from the Simon XT keypad.

f. Installer returns to web interface and is prompted to automatically set up cameras. After waiting for completion cameras are now provisioned and operational.

5. Installer instructs customer on use of the Simon XT, and shows customer how to log into the integrated security system web and mobile portals. Customer creates a username/password at this time.

6. Customer and Installer observe that all sensors/cameras are green.

7. Installer instructs customer how to change Simon XT user code from the keypad. Customer changes user code and stores in SimonXT.

8. The first time the customer uses the web portal to Arm/Disarm system the web interface prompts the customer for the user code, which is then stored securely on the server. In the event the user code is changed on the panel the web interface once again prompts the customer.

The panel of an embodiment can be programmed remotely. The CMS pushes new programming to SimonXT over a telephone or GPRS link. Optionally, iControl and GE provide a broadband link or coupling to the gateway and then a link from the gateway to the Simon XT over GE RF.

In addition to the configurations described above, the gateway of an embodiment supports takeover configurations in which it is introduced or added into a legacy security system. A description of example takeover configurations follow in which the security system (FIG. 2 , element 210) is a Dialog system and the WSP (FIG. 2 , element 211) is a GE Concord panel (e.g., equipped with POTS, GE RF, and Superbus 2000 RS485 interface (in the case of a Lynx takeover the Simon XT is used) available from General Electric Security. The gateway (FIG. 2 , element 220) in the takeover configurations is an iHub (e.g., equipped with built-in 802.11b/g router, Ethernet Hub, GSM/GPRS card, RS485 interface, and iControl Honeywell-compatible RF card) available from iControl Networks, Palo Alto, Calif. While components of particular manufacturers are used in this example, the embodiments are not limited to these components or to components from these vendors.

The security system can optionally include RF wireless sensors (e.g., GE wireless sensors utilizing the GE Dialog RF technology), IP cameras, a GE-iControl Touchscreen (the touchscreen is assumed to be an optional component in the configurations described herein, and is thus treated separately from the iHub; in systems in which the touchscreen is a component of the base security package, the integrated iScreen (available from iControl Networks, Palo Alto, Calif.) can be used to combine iHub technology with the touchscreen in a single unit), and Z-Wave devices to name a few.

The takeover configurations described below assume takeover by a “new” system of an embodiment of a security system provided by another third party vendor, referred to herein as an “original” or “legacy” system. Generally, the takeover begins with removal of the control panel and keypad of the legacy system. A GE Concord panel is installed to replace the control panel of the legacy system along with an iHub with GPRS Modem. The legacy system sensors are then connected or wired to the Concord panel, and a GE keypad or touchscreen is installed to replace the control panel of the legacy system. The iHub includes the iControl RF card, which is compatible with the legacy system. The iHub finds and manages the wireless sensors of the legacy system, and learns the sensors into the Concord by emulating the corresponding GE sensors. The iHub effectively acts as a relay for legacy wireless sensors.

Once takeover is complete, the new security system provides a homogeneous system that removes the compromises inherent in taking over or replacing a legacy system. For example, the new system provides a modern touchscreen that may include additional functionality, new services, and supports integration of sensors from various manufacturers. Furthermore, lower support costs can be realized because call centers, installers, etc. are only required to support one architecture. Additionally, there is minimal install cost because only the panel is required to be replaced as a result of the configuration flexibility offered by the iHub.

The system takeover configurations described below include but are not limited to a dedicated wireless configuration, a dedicated wireless configuration that includes a touchscreen, and a fished Ethernet configuration. Each of these configurations is described in detail below.

FIG. 18 is a block diagram of a security system in which the legacy panel is replaced with a GE Concord panel wirelessly coupled to an iHub, under an embodiment. All existing wired and RF sensors remain in place. The iHub is located near the Concord panel, and communicates with the panel via the 802.11 link, but is not so limited. The iHub manages cameras through a built-in 802.11 router. The iHub listens to the existing RF HW sensors, and relays sensor information to the Concord panel (emulating the equivalent GE sensor). The wired sensors of the legacy system are connected to the wired zones on the control panel.

FIG. 19 is a block diagram of a security system in which the legacy panel is replaced with a GE Concord panel wirelessly coupled to an iHub, and a GE-iControl Touchscreen, under an embodiment. All existing wired and RF sensors remain in place. The iHub is located near the Concord panel, and communicates with the panel via the 802.11 link, but is not so limited. The iHub manages cameras through a built-in 802.11 router. The iHub listens to the existing RF HW sensors, and relays sensor information to the Concord panel (emulating the equivalent GE sensor). The wired sensors of the legacy system are connected to the wired zones on the control panel.

The GE-iControl Touchscreen can be used with either of an 802.11 connection or Ethernet connection with the iHub. Because the takeover involves a GE Concord panel (or Simon XT), the touchscreen is always an option. No extra wiring is required for the touchscreen as it can use the 4-wire set from the replaced keypad of the legacy system. This provides power, battery backup (through Concord), and data link (RS485 Superbus 2000) between Concord and touchscreen. The touchscreen receives its broadband connectivity through the dedicated 802.11 link to the iHub.

FIG. 20 is a block diagram of a security system in which the legacy panel is replaced with a GE Concord panel connected to an iHub via an Ethernet coupling, under an embodiment. All existing wired and RF sensors remain in place. The iHub is located near the Concord panel, and wired to the panel using a 4-wire SUperbus 2000 (RS485) interface, but is not so limited. The iHub manages cameras through a built-in 802.11 router. The iHub listens to the existing RF HW sensors, and relays sensor information to the Concord panel (emulating the equivalent GE sensor). The wired sensors of the legacy system are connected to the wired zones on the control panel.

The takeover installation process is similar to the installation process described above, except the control panel of the legacy system is replaced; therefore, only the differences with the installation described above are provided here. The takeover approach of an embodiment uses the existing RS485 control interfaces that GE Security and iControl support with the iHub, touchscreen, and Concord panel. With these interfaces, the iHub is capable of automatically enrolling sensors in the panel. The exception is the leverage of an iControl RF card compatible with legacy systems to ‘takeover’ existing RF sensors. A description of the takeover installation process follows.

During the installation process, the iHub uses an RF Takeover Card to automatically extract all sensor IDs, zones, and names from the legacy panel. The installer removes connections at the legacy panel from hardwired wired sensors and labels each with the zone. The installer pulls the legacy panel and replaces it with the GE Concord panel. The installer also pulls the existing legacy keypad and replaces it with either a GE keypad or a GE-iControl touchscreen. The installer connects legacy hardwired sensors to appropriate wired zone (from labels) on the Concord. The installer connects the iHub to the local network and connects the iHub RS485 interface to the Concord panel. The iHub automatically ‘enrolls’ legacy RF sensors into the Concord panel as GE sensors (maps IDs), and pushes or otherwise propagates other information gathered from HW panel (zone, name, group). The installer performs a test of all sensors back to CMS. In operation, the iHub relays legacy sensor data to the Concord panel, emulating equivalent GE sensor behavior and protocols.

The areas of the installation process particular to the legacy takeover include how the iHub extracts sensor info from the legacy panel and how the iHub automatically enrolls legacy RF sensors and populates Concord with wired zone information. Each of these areas is described below.

In having the iHub extract sensor information from the legacy panel, the installer ‘enrolls’ iHub into the legacy panel as a wireless keypad (use install code and house ID—available from panel). The iHub legacy RF Takeover Card is a compatible legacy RF transceiver. The installer uses the web portal to place iHub into ‘Takeover Mode’, and the web portal the automatically instructs the iHub to begin extraction. The iHub queries the panel over the RF link (to get all zone information for all sensors, wired and RF). The iHub then stores the legacy sensor information received during the queries on the iConnect server.

The iHub also automatically enrolls legacy RF sensors and populates Concord with wired zone information. In so doing, the installer selects ‘Enroll legacy Sensors into Concord’ (next step in ‘Takeover’ process on web portal). The iHub automatically queries the iConnect server, and downloads legacy sensor information previously extracted. The downloaded information includes an ID mapping from legacy ID to ‘spoofed’ GE ID. This mapping is stored on the server as part of the sensor information (e.g., the iConnect server knows that the sensor is a legacy sensor acting in GE mode). The iHub instructs Concord to go into install mode, and sends appropriate Superbus 2000 commands for sensor learning to the panel. For each sensor, the ‘spoofed’ GE ID is loaded, and zone, name, and group are set based on information extracted from legacy panel. Upon completion, the iHub notifies the server, and the web portal is updated to reflect next phase of Takeover (e.g., ‘Test Sensors’).

Sensors are tested in the same manner as described above. When a HW sensor is triggered, the signal is captured by the iHub legacy RF Takeover Card, translated to the equivalent GE RF sensor signal, and pushed to the panel as a sensor event on the SuperBus 2000 wires.

In support of remote programming of the panel, CMS pushes new programming to Concord over a phone line, or to the iConnect CMS/Alarm Server API, which in turn pushes the programming to the iHub. The iHub uses the Concord Superbus 2000 RS485 link to push the programming to the Concord panel.

FIG. 21 is a flow diagram for automatic takeover 2100 of a security system, under an embodiment. Automatic takeover includes establishing 2102 a wireless coupling between a takeover component running under a processor and a first controller of a security system installed at a first location. The security system includes some number of security system components coupled to the first controller. The automatic takeover includes automatically extracting 2104 security data of the security system from the first controller via the takeover component. The automatic takeover includes automatically transferring 2106 the security data to a second controller and controlling loading of the security data into the second controller. The second controller is coupled to the security system components and replaces the first controller.

FIG. 22 is a flow diagram for automatic takeover 2200 of a security system, under an alternative embodiment. Automatic takeover includes automatically forming 2202 a security network at a first location by establishing a wireless coupling between a security system and a gateway. The gateway of an embodiment includes a takeover component. The security system of an embodiment includes security system components. The automatic takeover includes automatically extracting 2204 security data of the security system from a first controller of the security system. The automatic takeover includes automatically transferring 2206 the security data to a second controller. The second controller of an embodiment is coupled to the security system components and replaces the first controller.

Components of the gateway of the integrated security system described herein control discovery, installation and configuration of both wired and wireless IP devices (e.g., cameras, etc.) coupled or connected to the system, as described herein with reference to FIGS. 1-4 , as well as management of video routing using a video routing module or engine. The video routing engine initiates communication paths for the transfer of video from a streaming source device to a requesting client device, and delivers seamless video streams to the user via the communication paths using one or more of UPnP port-forwarding, relay server routing and STUN/TURN peer-to-peer routing, each of which is described below.

By way of reference, conventional video cameras have the ability to stream digital video in a variety of formats and over a variety of networks. Internet protocol (IP) video cameras, which include video cameras using an IP transport network (e.g., Ethernet, WiFi (IEEE 802.11 standards), etc.) are prevalent and increasingly being utilized in home monitoring and security system applications. With the proliferation of the internet, Ethernet and WiFi local area networks (LANs) and advanced wide area networks (WANs) that offer high bandwidth, low latency connections (broadband), as well as more advanced wireless WAN data networks (e.g. GPRS or CDMA 1×RTT), there increasingly exists the networking capability to extend traditional security systems to offer IP-based video. However, a fundamental reason for such IP video in a security system is to enable a user or security provider to monitor live or otherwise streamed video from outside the host premises (and the associated LAN).

The conventional solution to this problem has involved a technique known as ‘port forwarding’, whereby a ‘port’ on the LAN's router/firewall is assigned to the specific LAN IP address for an IP camera, or a proxy to that camera. Once a port has been ‘forwarded’ in this manner, a computer external to the LAN can address the LAN's router directly, and request access to that port. This access request is then forwarded by the router directly to the IP address specified, the IP camera or proxy. In this way an external device can directly access an IP camera within the LAN and view or control the streamed video.

The issues with this conventional approach include the following: port forwarding is highly technical and most users do not know how/why to do it; automatic port forwarding is difficult and problematic using emerging standards like UPnP; the camera IP address is often reset in response to a power outage/router reboot event; there are many different routers with different ways/capabilities for port forwarding. In short, although port forwarding can work, it is frequently less than adequate to support a broadly deployed security solution utilizing IP cameras.

Another approach to accessing streaming video externally to a LAN utilizes peer-to-peer networking technology. So-called peer-to-peer networks, which includes networks in which a device or client is connected directly to another device or client, typically over a Wide Area Network (WAN) and without a persistent server connection, are increasingly common. In addition to being used for the sharing of files between computers (e.g., Napster and KaZaa), peer-to-peer networks have also been more recently utilized to facilitate direct audio and media streaming in applications such as Skype. In these cases, the peer-to-peer communications have been utilized to enable telephony-style voice communications and video conferencing between two computers, each enabled with an IP-based microphone, speaker, and video camera. A fundamental reason for adopting such peer-to-peer technology is the ability to transparently ‘punch through’ LAN firewalls to enable external access to the streaming voice and video content, and to do so in a way that scales to tens of millions of users without creating an untenable server load.

A limitation of the conventional peer-to-peer video transport lies in the personal computer (PC)-centric nature of the solution. Each of the conventional solutions uses a highly capable PC connected to the video camera, with the PC providing the advanced software functionality required to initiate and manage the peer-to-peer connection with the remote client. A typical security or remote home monitoring system requires multiple cameras, each with its own unique IP address, and only a limited amount of processing capability in each camera such that the conventional PC-centric approach cannot easily solve the need. Instead of a typical PC-centric architecture with three components (a “3-way IP Video System”) that include a computer device with video camera, a mediating server, and a PC client with video display capability, the conventional security system adds a plurality of fourth components that are standalone IP video cameras (requiring a “4-way IP Video System”), another less-than-ideal solution.

In accordance with the embodiments described herein, IP camera management systems and methods are provided that enable a consumer or security provider to easily and automatically configure and manage IP cameras located at a customer premise. Using this system IP camera management may be extended to remote control and monitoring from outside the firewall and router of the customer premise.

With reference to FIGS. 5 and 6 , the system includes a gateway 253 having a video routing component so that the gateway 253 can manage and control, or assist in management and control, or video routing. The system also includes one or more cameras (e.g., WiFi IP camera 254, Ethernet IP camera 255, etc.) that communicate over the LAN 250 using an IP format, as well as a connection management server 210 located outside the premise firewall 252 and connected to the gateway 253 by a Wide Area Network (WAN) 200. The system further includes one or more devices 220, 230, 240 located outside the premise and behind other firewalls 221, 231, 241 and connected to the WAN 200. The other devices 220, 230, 240 are configured to access video or audio content from the IP cameras within the premise, as described above.

Alternatively, with reference to FIGS. 9 and 10 , the system includes a touchscreen 902 or 1002 having a video routing component so that the touchscreen 902 or 1002can manage and control, or assist in management and control, or video routing. The system also includes one or more cameras (e.g., WiFi IP camera 254, Ethernet IP camera 255, etc.) that communicate over the LAN 250 using an IP format, as well as a connection management server 210 located outside the premise firewall 252 and connected to the gateway 253 by a Wide Area Network (WAN) 200. The system further includes one or more devices 220, 230, 240 located outside the premise and behind other firewalls 221, 231, 241 and connected to the WAN 200. The other devices 220, 230, 240 are configured to access video or audio content from the IP cameras within the premise, as described above.

FIG. 23 is a general flow diagram for IP video control, under an embodiment. The IP video control interfaces, manages, and provides WAN-based remote access to a plurality of IP cameras in conjunction with a home security or remote home monitoring system. The IP video control allows for monitoring and controlling of IP video cameras from a location remote to the customer premise, outside the customer premise firewall, and protected by another firewall. Operations begin when the system is powered on 2310, involving at a minimum the power-on of the gateway, as well as the power-on of at least one IP camera coupled or connected to the premise LAN. The gateway searches 2311 for available IP cameras and associated IP addresses. The gateway selects 2312 from one or more possible approaches to create connections between the IP camera and a device external to the firewall. Once an appropriate connection path is selected, the gateway begins operation 2313, and awaits 2320 a request for a stream from one of the plurality of IP video cameras available on the LAN. When a stream request is present the server retrieves 2321 the requestor's WAN IP address/port.

When a server relay is present 2330, the IP camera is instructed 2331 to stream to the server, and the connection is managed 2332 through the server. In response to the stream terminating 2351, operations return to gateway operation 2313, and waits to receive another request 2320 for a stream from one of the plurality of IP video cameras available on the LAN.

When a server relay is not present 2330, the requestor's WAN IP address/port is provided 2333 to the gateway or gateway relay. When a gateway relay is present 2340, the IP camera is instructed 2341 to stream to the gateway, and the gateway relays 2342 the connection to the requestor. In response to the stream terminating 2351, operations return to gateway operation 2313, and waits to receive another request 2320 for a stream from one of the plurality of IP video cameras available on the LAN. When a gateway relay is not present 2340, the IP camera is instructed 2343 to stream to an address, and a handoff 2344 is made resulting in direct communication between the camera and the requestor. In response to the stream terminating 2351, operations return to gateway operation 2313, and waits to receive another request 2320 from one of the plurality of IP video cameras available on the LAN.

The integrated security system of an embodiment supports numerous video stream formats or types of video streams. Supported video streams include, but are not limited to, Motion Picture Experts Group (MPEG)-4 (MPEG-4)/Real-Time Streaming Protocol (RTSP), MPEG-4 over Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP), and Motion Joint Photographic Experts Group (JPEG) (MJPEG).

The integrated security system of an embodiment supports the MPEG-4/RTSP video streaming method (supported by video servers and clients) which uses RTSP for the control channel and Real-time Transport Protocol (RTP) for the data channel. Here the RTSP channel is over Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) while the data channel uses User Datagram Protocol (UDP). This method is widely supported by both streaming sources (e.g., cameras) and stream clients (e.g., remote client devices, Apple Quicktime, VideoLAN, IPTV mobile phones, etc).

Encryption can be added to the two channels under MPEG-4/RTSP. For example, the RTSP control channel can be encrypted using SSL/TLS. The data channel can also be encrypted.

If the camera or video stream source inside the home does not support encryption for either RTSP or RTP channels, the gateway located on the LAN can facilitate the encrypted RTSP method by maintaining separate TCP sessions with the video stream source device and with the encrypted RTSP client outside the LAN, and relay all communication between the two sessions. In this situation, any communication between the gateway and the video stream source that is not encrypted could be encrypted by the gateway before being relayed to the RTSP client outside the LAN. In many cases the gateway is an access point for the encrypted and private Wifi network on which the video stream source device is located. This means that communication between the gateway and the video stream source device is encrypted at the network level, and communication between the gateway and the RTSP client is encrypted at the transport level. In this fashion the gateway can compensate for a device that does not support encrypted RTSP.

The integrated security system of an embodiment also supports reverse RTSP. Reverse RTSP includes taking a TCP-based protocol like RTSP, and reversing the roles of client and server (references to “server” include the iControl server, also referred to as the iConnect server) when it comes to TCP session establishment. For example, in standard RTSP the RTSP client is the one that establishes the TCP connection with the stream source server (the server listens on a port for incoming connections). In Reverse RTSP, the RTSP client listens on a port for incoming connections from the stream source server. Once the TCP connection is established, the RTSP client begins sending commands to the server over the TCP connection just as it would in standard RTSP.

When using Reverse RTSP, the video stream source is generally on a LAN, protected by a firewall. Having a device on the LAN initiate the connection to the RTSP client outside the firewall enables easy network traversal.

If the camera or video stream source inside the LAN does not support Reverse RTSP, then the gateway facilitates the Reverse RTSP method by initiating separate TCP sessions with the video stream source device and with the Reverse RTSP client outside the LAN, and then relays all communication between the two sessions. In this fashion the gateway compensates for a stream source device that does not support Reverse RTSP.

As described in the encryption description above, the gateway can further compensate for missing functionalities on the device such as encryption. If the device does not support encryption for either RTSP or RTP channels, the gateway can communicate with the device using these un-encrypted streams, and then encrypt the streams before relaying them out of the LAN to the RTSP Reverse client.

Servers of the integrated security system can compensate for RTSP clients that do not support Reverse RTSP. In this situation, the server accepts TCP connections from both the RTSP client and the Reverse RTSP video stream source (which could be a gateway acting on behalf of a stream source device that does not support Reverse RTSP). The server then relays the control and video streams from the Reverse RTSP video stream source to the RTSP client. The server can further compensate for the encryption capabilities of the RTSP client; if the RTSP client does not support encryption then the server can provide an unencrypted stream to the RTSP client even though an encrypted stream was received from the Reverse RTSP streaming video source.

The integrated security system of an embodiment also supports Simple Traversal of User Datagram Protocol (UDP) through Network Address Translators (NAT) (STUN)/Traversal Using Relay NAT (TURN) peer-to-peer routing. STUN and Turn are techniques for using a server to help establish a peer-to-peer UDP data stream (it does not apply to TCP streams). The bandwidth consumed by the data channel of a video stream is usually many thousands of times larger than that used by the control channel. Consequently, when a peer-to-peer connection for both the RTSP and RTP channels is not possible, there is still a great incentive to use STUN/TURN techniques in order to achieve a peer-to-peer connection for the RTP data channel.

Here, a method referred to herein as RTSP with STUN/TURN is used by the integrated security system. The RTSP with STUN/TURN is a method in which the video streaming device is instructed over the control channel to stream its UDP data channel to a different network address than that of the other end of the control TCP connection (usually the UDP data is simply streamed to the IP address of the RTSP client). The result is that the RTSP or Reverse RTSP TCP channel can be relayed using the gateway and/or the server, while the RTP UDP data channel can flow directly from the video stream source device to the video stream client.

If a video stream source device does not support RTSP with STUN/TURN, the gateway can compensate for the device by relaying the RTSP control channel via the server to the RTSP client, and receiving the RTP data channel and then forwarding it directly to the RTSP with STUN/TURN enabled client. Encryption can also be added here by the gateway.

The integrated security system of an embodiment supports MPEG-4 over HTTP. MPEG-4 over HTTP is similar to MPEG-4 over RTSP except that both the RTSP control channel and the RTP data channel are passed over an HTTP TCP session. Here a single TCP session can be used, splitting it into multiple channels using common HTTP techniques like chunked transfer encoding.

The MPEG-4 over HTTP is generally supported by many video stream clients and server devices, and encryption can easily be added to it using SSL/TLS. Because it uses TCP for both channels, STUN/TURN techniques may not apply in the event that a direct peer-to-peer TCP session between client and server cannot be established.

As described above, encryption can be provided using SSL/TLS taking the form of HTTPS. And as with MPEG-4 over RTSP, a gateway can compensate for a stream source device that does not support encryption by relaying the TCP streams and encrypting the TCP stream between the gateway and the stream client. In many cases the gateway is an access point for the encrypted and private Wifi network on which the video stream source device is located. This means that communication between the gateway and the video stream source device is encrypted at the network level, and communication between the gateway and the video stream client is encrypted at the transport level. In this fashion the gateway can compensate for a device that does not support HTTPS.

As with Reverse RTSP, the integrated security system of an embodiment supports Reverse HTTP. Reverse HTTP includes taking a TCP-based protocol like HTTP, and reversing the roles of client and server when it comes to TCP session establishment. For example, in conventional HTTP the HTTP client is the one that establishes the TCP connection with the server (the server listens on a port for incoming connections). In Reverse HTTP, the HTTP client listens on a port for incoming connections from the server. Once the TCP connection is established, the HTTP client begins sending commands to the server over the TCP connection just as it would in standard HTTP.

When using Reverse HTTP, the video stream source is generally on a LAN, protected by a firewall. Having a device on the LAN initiate the connection to the HTTP client outside the firewall enables easy network traversal.

If the camera or video stream source inside the LAN does not support Reverse HTTP, then the gateway can facilitate the Reverse HTTP method by initiating separate TCP sessions with the video stream source device and with the Reverse HTTP client outside the LAN, and then relay all communication between the two sessions. In this fashion the gateway can compensate for a stream source device that does not support Reverse HTTP.

As described in the encryption description above, the gateway can further compensate for missing functionalities on the device such as encryption. If the device does not support encrypted HTTP (e.g., HTTPS), then the gateway can communicate with the device using HTTP, and then encrypt the TCP stream(s) before relaying out of the LAN to the Reverse HTTP client.

The servers of an embodiment can compensate for HTTP clients that do not support Reverse HTTP. In this situation, the server accepts TCP connections from both the HTTP client and the Reverse HTTP video stream source (which could be a gateway acting on behalf of a stream source device that does not support Reverse HTTP). The server then relays the TCP streams from the Reverse HTTP video stream source to the HTTP client. The server can further compensate for the encryption capabilities of the HTTP client; if the HTTP client does not support encryption then the server can provide an unencrypted stream to the HTTP client even though an encrypted stream was received from the Reverse HTTP streaming video source.

The integrated security system of an embodiment supports MJPEG as described above. MJPEG is a streaming technique in which a series of JPG images are sent as the result of an HTTP request. Because MJPEG streams are transmitted over HTTP, HTTPS can be employed for encryption and most MJPEG clients support the resulting encrypted stream. And as with MPEG-4 over HTTP, a gateway can compensate for a stream source device that does not support encryption by relaying the TCP streams and encrypting the TCP stream between the gateway and the stream client. In many cases the gateway is an access point for the encrypted and private Wifi network on which the video stream source device is located. This means that communication between the gateway and the video stream source device is encrypted at the network level, and communication between the gateway and the video stream client is encrypted at the transport level. In this fashion the gateway can compensate for a device that does not support HTTPS.

The integrated system of an embodiment supports Reverse HTTP. Reverse HTTP includes taking a TCP-based protocol like HTTP, and reversal of the roles of client and server when it comes to TCP session establishment can be employed for MJPEG streams. For example, in standard HTTP the HTTP client is the one who establishes the TCP connection with the server (the server listens on a port for incoming connections). In Reverse HTTP, the HTTP client listens on a port for incoming connections from the server. Once the TCP connection is established, the HTTP client begins sending commands to the server over the TCP connection just as it would in standard HTTP.

When using Reverse HTTP, the video stream source is generally on a LAN, protected by a firewall. Having a device on the LAN initiate the connection to the HTTP client outside the firewall enables network traversal.

If the camera or video stream source inside the LAN does not support Reverse HTTP, then the gateway can facilitate the Reverse HTTP method by initiating separate TCP sessions with the video stream source device and with the Reverse HTTP client outside the LAN, and then relay all communication between the two sessions. In this fashion the gateway can compensate for a stream source device that does not support Reverse HTTP.

As described in the encryption description above, the gateway can further compensate for missing functionalities on the device such as encryption. If the device does not support encrypted HTTP (e.g., HTTPS), then the gateway can communicate with the device using HTTP, and then encrypt the TCP stream(s) before relaying out of the LAN to the Reverse HTTP client.

The servers can compensate for HTTP clients that do not support Reverse HTTP. In this situation, the server accepts TCP connections from both the HTTP client and the Reverse HTTP video stream source (which could be a gateway acting on behalf of a stream source device that does not support Reverse HTTP). The server then relays the TCP streams from the Reverse HTTP video stream source to the HTTP client. The server can further compensate for the encryption capabilities of the HTTP client; if the HTTP client does not support encryption then the server can provide an unencrypted stream to the HTTP client even though an encrypted stream was received from the Reverse HTTP streaming video source.

The integrated security system of an embodiment considers numerous parameters in determining or selecting one of the streaming formats described above for use in transferring video streams. The parameters considered in selecting a streaming format include, but are not limited to, security requirements, client capabilities, device capabilities, and network/system capabilities.

The security requirements for a video stream are considered in determining an applicable streaming format in an embodiment. Security requirements fall into two categories, authentication and privacy, each of which is described below.

Authentication as a security requirement means that stream clients must present credentials in order to obtain a stream. Furthermore, this presentation of credentials should be done in a way that is secure from network snooping and replays. An example of secure authentication is Basic Authentication over HTTPS. Here a username and password are presented over an encrypted HTTPS channel so snooping and replays are prevented. Basic Authentication alone, however, is generally not sufficient for secure authentication.

Because not all streaming clients support SSL/TLS, authentication methods that do not require it are desirable. Such methods include Digest Authentication and one-time requests. A one-time request is a request that can only be made by a client one time, and the server prevents a reuse of the same request. One-time requests are used to control access to a stream source device by stream clients that do not support SSL/TLS. An example here is providing video access to a mobile phone. Typical mobile phone MPEG-4 viewers do not support encryption. In this case, one of the MPEG-4 over RTSP methods described above can be employed to get the video stream relayed to an server. The server can then provide the mobile phone with a one-time request Universal Resource Locator (URL) for the relayed video stream source (via a Wireless Application Protocol (WAP) page). Once the stream ends, the mobile phone would need to obtain another one-time request URL from the server (via WAP, for example) in order to view the stream again.

Privacy as a security requirement means that the contents of the video stream must be encrypted. This is a requirement that may be impossible to satisfy on clients that do not support video stream encryption, for example many mobile phones. If a client supports encryption for some video stream format(s), then the “best” of those formats should be selected. Here “best” is determined by the stream type priority algorithm.

The client capabilities are considered in determining an applicable streaming format in an embodiment. In considering client capabilities, the selection depends upon the supported video stream formats that include encryption, and the supported video stream formats that do not support encryption.

The device capabilities are considered in determining an applicable streaming format in an embodiment. In considering device capabilities, the selection depends upon the supported video stream formats that include encryption, the supported video stream formats that do not support encryption, and whether the device is on an encrypted private Wifi network managed by the gateway (in which case encryption at the network level is not required).

The network/system capabilities are considered in determining an applicable streaming format in an embodiment. In considering network/system capabilities, the selection depends upon characteristics of the network or system across which the stream must travel. The characteristics considered include, for example, the following: whether there is a gateway and/or server on the network to facilitate some of the fancier video streaming types or security requirements; whether the client is on the same LAN as the gateway, meaning that network firewall traversal is not needed.

Streaming methods with the highest priority are peer-to-peer because they scale best with server resources. Universal Plug and Play (UPnP) can be used by the gateway to open ports on the video stream device's LAN router and direct traffic through those ports to the video stream device. This allows a video stream client to talk directly with the video stream device or talk directly with the gateway which can in turn facilitate communication with the video stream device.

Another factor in determining the best video stream format to use is the success of STUN and TURN methods for establishing direct peer-to-peer UDP communication between the stream source device and the stream client. Again, the gateway and the server can help with the setup of this communication.

Client bandwidth availability and processing power are other factors in determining the best streaming methods. For example, due to its bandwidth overhead an encrypted MJPEG stream should not be considered for most mobile phone data networks.

Device bandwidth availability can also be considered in choosing the best video stream format. For example, consideration can be given to whether the upstream bandwidth capabilities of the typical residential DSL support two or more simultaneous MJPEG streams.

Components of the integrated security system of an embodiment, while considering various parameters in selecting a video streaming format to transfer video streams from streaming source devices and requesting client devices, prioritize streaming formats according to these parameters. The parameters considered in selecting a streaming format include, as described above, security requirements, client capabilities, device capabilities, and network/system capabilities. Components of the integrated security system of an embodiment select a video streaming format according to the following priority, but alternative embodiments can use other priorities.

The selected format is UPnP or peer-to-peer MPEG-4 over RTSP with encryption when both requesting client device and streaming source device support this format.

The selected format is UPnP or peer-to-peer MPEG-4 over RTSP with authentication when the requesting client device does not support encryption or UPnP or peer-to-peer MPEG-4 over RTSP with encryption.

The selected format is UPnP (peer-to-peer) MPEG-4 over HTTPS when both requesting client device and streaming source device support this format.

The selected format is UPnP (peer-to-peer) MPEG-4 over HTTP when the requesting client device does not support encryption or UPnP (peer-to-peer) MPEG-4 over HTTPS.

The selected format is UPnP (peer-to-peer) MPEG-4 over RTSP facilitated by gateway or touchscreen (including or incorporating gateway components) (to provide encryption), when the requesting client device supports encrypted RTSP and the streaming source device supports MPEG-4 over RTSP.

The selected format is UPnP (peer-to-peer) MPEG-4 over HTTPS facilitated by gateway or touchscreen (including or incorporating gateway components) (to provide encryption) when the requesting client device supports MPEG-4 over HTTPS and the streaming source device supports MPEG-4 over HTTP.

The selected format is UPnP (peer-to-peer) MJPEG over HTTPS when the networks and devices can handle the bandwidth and both requesting client device and streaming source device support MJPEG over HTTPS.

The selected format is Reverse RTSP with STUN/TURN facilitated by the server when the streaming source device initiates SSL/TLS TCP to server, the streaming source device supports Reverse RTSP over SSL/TLS with STUN/TURN, and the requesting client device supports RTSP with STUN/TURN.

The selected format is Reverse RTSP with STUN/TURN facilitated by server and gateway or touchscreen (including or incorporating gateway components) when the gateway initiates SSL/TLS TCP to the server and to the streaming source device, the streaming source device supports RTSP, and the requesting client device supports RTSP with STUN/TURN.

The selected format is Reverse MPEG over RTSP/HTTP facilitated by the server when the streaming source device initiates SSL/TLS TCP to server, the streaming source device supports Reverse RTSP or HTTP over SSL/TLS, and the requesting client device supports MPEG over RTSP/HTTP.

The selected format is Reverse MPEG over RTSP/HTTP facilitated by server and gateway or touchscreen (including or incorporating gateway components) when the gateway initiates SSL/TLS TCP to server and to streaming source device, the streaming source device supports MPEG over RTSP or HTTP, and the requesting client device supports MPEG over RTSP/HTTP.

The selected format is UPnP (peer-to-peer) MJPEG over HTTP when the networks and devices can handle the bandwidth and when the requesting client device does not support encryption and does not support MPEG-4.

The selected format is Reverse MJPEG over HTTPS facilitated by the server when the streaming source device initiates SSL/TLS TCP to server, the streaming source device supports Reverse MJPEG over SSL/TLS, and the requesting client device supports MJPEG.

The selected format is Reverse MJPEG over HTTPS facilitated by server and gateway or touchscreen (including or incorporating gateway components) when the gateway initiates SSL/TLS TCP to the server and to the streaming source device, the streaming source device supports MJPEG, and the requesting client device supports MJPEG.

-   -   FIG. 24 is a block diagram showing camera tunneling, under an         embodiment. Additional detailed description of camera tunnel         implementation details follow. An embodiment uses XMPP for         communication with a remote video camera as a lightweight         (bandwidth) method for maintaining real-time communication with         the remote camera. More specifically, the remote camera is         located on another NAT (e.g., NAT traversal).

An embodiment comprises a method for including a remotely located camera in a home automation system. For example, using XMPP via cloud XMPP server to couple or connect camera to home automation system. This can be used with in-car cameras, cell phone cameras, and re-locatable cameras (e.g., dropped in the office, the hotel room, the neighbor's house, etc.).

Components of an embodiment are distributed so that any one can be offline while system continues to function (e.g., panel can be down while camera still up, motion detection from camera, video clip upload etc. continue to work.

Embodiments extend the PSIA in one or more of the following areas: wifi roaming configuration; video relay commands; wifi connectivity test; media tunnel for live video streaming in the context of a security system; motion notification mechanism and configuration (motion heartbeat) (e.g., helps with scalable server); XMPP for lightweight communication (helps with scalable server, reduced bandwidth, for maintaining persistent connection with a gateway); ping request sent over XMPP as health check mechanism; shared secret authentication bootstrapping process; asynchronous error status delivery by the camera for commands invoked by the gateway if the camera is responsible for delivering errors to the gateway in an asynchronous fashion (e.g., gateway requests a firmware update or a video clip upload).

Embodiments extend the home automation system to devices located on separate networks, and make them usable as general-purpose communication devices. These cameras can be placed in the office, vacation home, neighbor house, software can be put onto a cell phone, into a car, navigation system, etc.

Embodiments use a global device registry for enabling a device/camera to locate the server and home to which it is assigned.

Embodiments include methods for bootstrapping and re-bootstrapping of authentication credentials. The methods include activation key entry by installer into the cloud web interface. Activation key generation is based upon mac address and a shared secret between manufacturer and the service provider. Embodiments of the system allow activation of a camera with valid activation key that is not already provisioned in the global registry server.

Embodiments include a web-based interface for use in activating, configuring, remote firmware update, and re-configuring of a camera.

Embodiments process or locate local wifi access points and provide these as options during camera configuring and re-configuring. Embodiments generate and provide recommendations around choosing a best wifi access point based upon characteristics of the network (e.g., signal strength, error rates, interference, etc.). Embodiments include methods for testing and diagnosing issues with wifi and network access.

Embodiments include cameras able to perform this wifi test using only one physical network interface, an approach that enables the camera to dynamically change this physical interface from wired to wifi. Embodiments are able to change the network settings (wifi etc) remotely using the same process.

Cameras of an embodiment can be configured with multiple network preferences with priority order so that the camera can move between different locations and the camera can automatically find the best network to join (e.g., can have multiple ssid+bssid+password sets configured and prioritized).

Regarding firmware download, embodiments include a mechanism to monitor the status of the firmware update, provide feedback to the end user and improve overall quality of the system.

Embodiments use RTSP over SSL to a cloud media relay server to allow live video NAT traversal to a remote client (e.g., PC, cell phone, etc.) in a secure manner where the camera provides media session authentication credentials to the server. The camera initiates the SSL connection to the cloud and then acts as a RTSP server over this connection.

Embodiments include methods for using NAT traversal for connecting to the cloud for remote management and live video access allows the integrated security components to avoid port forwarding on the local router(s) and as a result maintain a more secure local network and a more secure camera since no ports are required to be open.

Embodiments enable camera sensors (e.g., motion, audio, heat, etc.) to serve as triggers to other actions in the automation system. The capture of video clips or snapshots from the camera is one such action, but the embodiments are not so limited.

A camera of an embodiment can be used by multiple systems.

A detailed description of flows follows relating to the camera tunnel of an embodiment.

A detailed description of camera startup and installation follows as it pertains to the camera tunnel of an embodiment.

Activation Key

a. camera to follow same algorithm as ihub where activation key is generated from serial based upon a one-way hash on serial and a per-vendor shared secret.

b. Used com.icontrol.util.ops.activation.ActivationKeyUtil class to validate serialNo<->activationKey.

Registry Request

[partner]/registry/[device type]/[serial]

a. new column in existing registry table for id type; nullable but the application treats null as “gateway”.

b. rest endpoints allow adding with the new optional argument.

c. current serial and siteId uniqueness enforcement by application depends upon device type (for any device type, there should be uniqueness on serial; for gateway device type, there should be uniqueness on siteId; for other device types, there need not be uniqueness on siteId).

d. if no activation yet (e.g., no entry) then send dummy response (random but repeatable reply; may include predictable “dummy” so that steps below can infer.

e. add/update registry server endpoints for adding/updating entries.

If Camera has no Password

Camera retrieves “Pending Key” via POST to /<CredentialGatewayURL>/GatewayService/<siteID>/PendingDeviceKey.

a. pending key request (to get password) with serial and activation key.

b. server checks for dummy reply; if dummy then responds with retry backoff response.

c. server invokes pass-through API on gateway to get new pending key.

d. if device is found, then gateway performs validation of serial+activation key, returns error if mismatch.

e. if activation key checks out, then gateway checks pending key status.

f. if device currently has a pending key status, then a new pending password is generated.

g. gateway maintains this authorization information in a new set of variables on the camera device.

h. device-authorization/session-key comprises the current connected password.

i. device-authorization/pending-expiry comprises a UTC timestamp representing the time the current pending password period ends; any value less than the current time or blank means the device is not in a pending password state.

j. device-authorization/pending-session-key comprises the last password returned to the camera in a pending request; this is optional (device may choose to maintain this value in memory).

k. session-key and pending-session-key variables tagged with “encryption” in the device def which causes rest and admin to hide their value from client.

ConnectInfo Request

a. returns xmpp host and port to connect to (comes from config as it does for gateway connect info).

b. returns connectInfo with additional <xmpp> parameter.

Start Portal Add Camera Wizard

a. user enters camera serial, activation key.

b. addDevice rest endpoint on gateway called

c. gateway verifies activation key is correct.

d. gateway calls addDevice method on gapp server to add LWG_SerComm_iCamera_1000 with given serial to site.

e. Server detects the camera type and populates registry.

f. gateway puts device into pending password state (e.g., updates device-auth/pending-expiry point).

g. rest endpoints on gateway device for managing device pending password state.

h. start pending password state: POST future UTC value to device-auth/pending-expiry; device-auth/pending-expiry set to 30 minutes from time device was added.

i. stop pending password state: POST −1 to device-auth/pending-expiry.

j. check pending password state: GET device-auth/pending-expiry.

k. message returned with “Location” header pointing to relative URI.

l. user told to power on camera (or reboot if already powered on).

m. once camera connects, gateway updates device-auth/pending-expiry to −1 and device-auth/session-key with password and device/connection-status to connected

n. portal polls for device/connection-status to change to connected; if does not connect after X seconds, bring up error page (camera has not connected—continue waiting or start over).

o. user asked if wifi should be configured for this camera.

p. entry fields for wifi ssid and password.

q. portal can pre-populate ssid and password fields with picklist of any from other cameras on the site.

r. get XML, of available SSIDs.

s. non-wifi option is allowed.

t. portal submits options to configure camera (use null values to specify non-wifi); upon success, message is returned with “Location” header pointing to relative URI.

u. checks configuration progress and extracting “status” and “sub State” fields.

v. puts device state into “configuring”; upon error, puts device state into “configuration failure”.

w. performs firmware upgrade if needed, placing device state into “upgrading”; upon error, puts device state into “upgrade failure”.

x. upon configuration success, puts device state of “ok” and applies appropriate configuration for camera (e.g., resolutions, users, etc.).

y. if non-blank wifi parameters, automatically perform “wifi test” method to test wifi without disconnecting Ethernet.

z. portal wizard polls device status until changes to “ok” or “upgrade failure/”configuration failure” in “status” field, along with applicable, if any, with error code reason, in “subState” field; upon error, show details to user, provide options (start over, configure again, reboot, factory reset, etc)

aa. notify user they can move camera to desired location.

Camera Reboots

a. gets siteId and server URL from registry.

b. makes pending paid key request to server specifying correct siteId, serial and activation key; gets back pending password.

c. makes connectInfo request to get xmpp server.

d. connects over xmpp with pending password.

If Camera Reboots Again

a. get siteId and server URL from registry.

b. already has password (may or may not be pending) so no need to perform pending paid key request.

c. make connectInfo request to get xmpp server.

d. connect over xmpp with password.

xmpp Connect with Password

a. xmpp user is of the form [serial]@[server]/[siteId]

b. session server performs authentication by making passthrough API request to gateway for given SiteId.

c. Session xmpp server authenticates new session using DeviceKey received in GET request against received xmpp client credential.

d. If authentication fails or GET receives non-response, server returns to camera XMPP connect retry backoff with long backoff.

e. gateway device performs password management.

f. compares password with current key and pending key (if not expired); if matches pending, then update device-auth/session-key to be pending value, and clear out the device-auth/pending-expiry.

g. gateway device updates the device/connection-status point to reflect that camera is connected.

h. gateway device tracks the xmpp session server this camera is connected to via new point device/proxy-host and updates this info if changed.

i. if deviceConnected returns message, then session server posts connected event containing xmpp user to queue monitored by all session servers.

j. session servers monitor these events and disconnect/cleanup sessions they have for same user.

k. may use new API endpoint on session server for broadcast messages.

xmpp Connect with Bad Password

a. Upon receiving a new connection request, session server performs authentication by making passthrough API request to gateway for given SiteId.

b. Session xmpp server authenticates new session using DeviceKey received in above GET request against received xmpp client credential.

c. If authentication fails or GET receives non-response from virtual gateway.

d. Session server rejects incoming connection (is there a backoff/retry XMPP response that can be sent here).

e. Session server logs event.

f. Gateway logs event.

xmpp Disconnect

a. session server posts disconnected event to gateway (with session server name).

b. gateway updates the device/connected variable/point to reflect that camera is disconnected.

c. gateway updates the device/connection-status variable/point to reflect that camera is disconnected.

d. gateway clears the device/proxy-host point that contains the session host to this camera is connected.

LWGW Shutdown

a. During LWGW shutdown, gateway can broadcast messages to all XMPP servers to ensure all active XMPP sessions are gracefully shutdown.

b. gateways use REST client to call URI, which will broadcast to all XMPP servers.

To Configure Camera During Installation

a. applies all appropriate configuration for camera (e.g., resolutions, users, etc).

b. returns message for configuration applied, wifi test passed, all settings taken. returns other response code with error code description upon any failure.

To Reconfigure Wifi SSID and Key

a. returns message for wifi credentials set.

b. returns other response code with error code description upon any failure.

API Pass-Through Handling for Gateway Fail-Over Case

a. When performing passthrough for LWGW, the API endpoint handles the LWGW failover case (e.g., when gateway is not currently running on any session server).

b. passthrough functions in the following way: current session server IP is maintained on the gateway object; server looks up gateway object to get session IP and then sends passthrough request to that session server; if that request returns gateway not found message, server error message, or a network level error (e.g., cannot route to host, etc.), if the gateway is a LWGW then server should lookup the primary/secondary LW Gateway group for this site; server should then send resume message to primary, followed by rest request; if that fails, then server send resume message to secondary followed by rest request

c. alternatively, passthrough functions in the following way: rather than lookup session server IP on gateway object, passthrough requests should be posted to a passthrough queue that is monitored by all session servers; the session server with the Gateway on it should consume the message (and pass it to the appropriate gateway); the server should monitor for expiry of these messages, and if the gateway is a LWGW then server should lookup the primary/secondary LW Gateway group for this site; server should then send resume message to primary, followed by rest request; if that fails, then server send resume message to secondary followed by rest request.

A detailed description follows for additional flows relating to the camera tunnel of an embodiment.

Motion Detection

a. camera sends openhome motion event to session server via xmpp.

b. session server posts motion event to gateway via passthrough API.

c. gateway updates the camera motion variable/point to reflect the event gateway updates the camera motion variable/point to reflect the event

Capture Snapshot

a. gateway posts openhome snapshot command to session server with camera connected.

b. gateway sends command including xmpp user id to xmpp command Queue monitored by all session servers.

c. session server with given xmpp user id consumes command and sends command to camera (command contains upload URL on gw webapp).

d. gateway starts internal timer to check if a response is received from camera (e.g., 5 sec wait window).

e. if broadcast RabbitMQ not ready, then gateway will use device/proxy-host value to know which session server to post command to.

f. session server sends command to camera (comprises upload URL on gw webapp)

g. Example XML body:

<MediaUpload> <id>1321896772660</id> <snapShotImageType>JPEG</snapShotImageType> <gateway_url>[gatewaysyncUrl]/gw/GatewayService/SPutJpg/s/[siteId]/ [deviceIndex]/[varValue]/[varIndex]/[who]/[ts]/[HMM]/[passCheck]/</ <failure_url>[gatewaysyncUrl]/gw/GatewayService/SPutJpgError/s/ [siteId]/[deviceIndex]/[varValue]/[varIndex]/[who]/[ts]/[HMM]/ [passCheck]/</ </MediaUpload>

h. session server receives response to sendRequestEvent from camera and posts response to gateway.

i. camera uploads to upload URL on gw webapp.

j. passCheck can be verified on server (based upon gateway secret); alternatively, the OpenHome spec calls for Digest Auth here.

k. endpoint responds with message digest password if the URI is expected, otherwise returns non-response.

l. gw webapp stores snapshot, logs history event.

m. event is posted to gateway for deltas.

Capture Clip

a. gateway posts openhome video clip capture command to session server with camera connected.

b. gateway sends command including xmpp user id to xmpp command Queue monitored by all session servers.

c. session server with given xmpp user id consumes command and sends command to camera (command comprises upload URL on gw webapp).

d. gateway starts internal timer to check if a response is received from camera (e.g., 5 sec wait window).

e. session server sends command to camera (comprises upload URL on gw webapp).

f. Example URI from session server to camera: /openhome/streaming/channels/1/video/upload

g. Example XML body:

<MediaUpload> <id>1321898092270</id> <videoClipFormatType>MP4</videoClipFormatType> <gateway_url>[gatewaysyncUrl]/gw/GatewayService/SPutMpeg/s/ [siteId]/[deviceIndex]/[varValue]/[varIndex]/[who]/[ts]/[HMM]/ [passCheck]/</<failure_url>[gatewaysyncUrl]/gw/GatewayService/ SPutMpegFailed/s/[siteId]/[deviceIndex]/[varValue]/[varIndex]/[who]/ [ts]/[HMM]/[passCheck]/</ </MediaUpload>

h. session server receives response to sendRequestEvent from camera and posts response to gateway.

i. camera uploads to upload URL on gw webapp.

j. passCheck can be verified on server (based upon gateway secret).

k. alternatively, spec calls for Digest Auth here.

l. endpoint responds with message digest password if the URI is expected, otherwise returns non-response.

m. gw webapp stores video clip, logs history event.

n. event is posted to gateway for deltas.

Live Video (Relay)

a. Upon user login to portal, portal creates a media relay tunnel by calling relayAPImanager create.

b. RelayAPImanager creates relays and sends ip-config-relay variable (which instructs gateway to create media tunnel) to gateway.

c. Upon receiving media tunnel create ip-config-relay command, gateway posts openhome media channel create command to session server with camera connected.

d. session server sends create media tunnel command to camera (comprises camera relay URL on relay server).

e. Example URI from session server to camera: /openhome/streaming/mediatunnel/create

f. Example XML body:

  <CreateMediaTunnel> <sessionID>1</sessionID> <gatewayURL>TBD</gatewayURL> <failureURL>TBD</failureURL> </CreateMediaTunnel>

g. GatewayURL is created from relay server, port, and sessionId info included within ip-config-relay variable.

h. camera creates a TLS tunnel to relay server via POST to <gatewayURL>.

i. When user initiates live video, portal determines user is remote and retrieves URL of Relay server from relayAPImanager.

j. Upon receiving a user pole connection on the relay server (along with valid rtsp request), relay sends streaming command to camera: example: rtsp:://openhome/streaming/channels/1/rtsp

k. Upon user portal logout, portals calls relayAPImanager to terminate media tunnel.

l. RelayAPImanager send ip-config-relay variable to terminate media tunnel.

m. Gateway sends destroy media tunnel command to camera via XMPP.

Camera Firmware Update

a. Gateway checks camera firmware version; if below minimum version, gateway sends command to camera (via session server) to upgrade firmware (command: /openhome/system/updatefirmware).

b. Gateway checks firmware update status by polling: /openhome/system/updatefirmware/status.

c. Gateway informs portal of upgrade status.

d. Camera auto-reboots after firmware update and reconnects to Session server.

Camera First-Contact Configuration

a. After a camera is added successfully and is connected to the session server for the first time, gateway performs first contact configuration as follows.

b. Check firmware version.

c. Configure settings by: download config file using /openhome/system/configurationData/configFile; or configure each category individually (configure video input channel settings—/openhome/system/video/inputs/channels; configure audio input channel settings (if any)—/openhome/system/audio/inputs/channels; configure video streaming channel settings—/openhome/streaming/channels; configure motion detection settings—example: PUT /openhome/custom/motiondetection/pir/0; configure event trigger settings—example: PUT /openhome/custom/event).

d. Reboot camera (/openhome/system/factoryreset) if camera responds with reboot required.

More particularly, details follow of a camera interface specification (LWG CAMERA INTERFACE SPECIFICATION) in an example embodiment of the integrated security system described herein.

1 Introduction

This document describes the communication protocol used between an iControl OpenHome-compatible Camera (OpenHome Camera) and the iControl Gateway. The OpenHome camera is an IP camera that supports the iControl OpenHome Camera Interface Specification and its associated requirements. The iControl Gateway is composed of several logical components—Registry Gateway, Credential Gateway, Premise Gateway (optional), and the Session Gateway. The OpenHome camera communicates with the iControl Gateway over IP networks (could be LAN or Internet) using standard network protocols such as HTTP/HTTPS, and XMPP (RFC 6120). In one deployment scenario, one or more OpenHome cameras are deployed at the customer premise in conjunction with a Premise Gateway, communicating with iControl Registry, Credential, and Session Gateways over the Internet (see FIG. 25 ). In another deployment scenario, OpenHome cameras are deployed at the customer premise without the Premise Gateway (see FIG. 26 ). Both deployment scenarios are supported by this interface specification.

Henceforth in this document, the OpenHome-compatible camera is referred to as Camera. The iControl Session Gateway, is simply referred to as the Session Gateway, the iControl Registry Gateway, is referred to as the Registry Gateway, the iControl Premise Gateway is referred to as the Premise Gateway, and the iControl Credential Gateway is referred to as the Credential Gateway. Finally, the collective name for all three gateway logical components is referred to as the iControl Gateway.

2 Communication Interface Overview

2.1 Camera Deployment with Premise Gateway

FIG. 25 illustrates a deployment scenario where the Camera is deployed in conjunction with a Premise Gateway at the customer premise.

Under this deployment scenario, the Camera and the Premise Gateway are deployed within the customer premise. The Local Bootstrap Procedures interface is used to discover and configure the Camera for subsequent accesses. The HTTPS Command/Notification interface is a bi-directional interface used by the Gateway to send Commands to the Camera or for the Camera to send Notifications to the Gateway. The Secure Streaming Media Channels interface is used to tunnel live RTSP or MJPEG streams from Camera to Gateway. The Media Upload Channels interface is used to upload video and image from Camera to Gateway. The HTTPS Notification interface is just a subset of the Command/Notification interface and is used by the Camera to post Notifications to the Gateway. An OpenHome camera when deployed in the Premise Gateway deployment scenario must support all four interface types described above.

2.2 Camera Deployment with Off-Premise Gateway

FIG. 26 illustrates a deployment scenario where the Camera is deployed without requiring a Premise Gateway at the customer premise.

Under this deployment scenario, the use of Premise Gateway within the customer premise is not required (but could optionally be deployed). The Off-Premise Bootstrap Procedures interface is used to discover and configure the Camera with siteID, shared secret, Session Gateway address, and other run-time parameters. The XMPP Command/Notification interface is a persistent bi-directional interface used by the Gateway to send Commands to the Camera or for the Camera to send Notifications to the Gateway. The Secure Streaming Media Channels interface is used to tunnel live RTSP or MJPEG streams from Camera to Gateway. The Media Upload Channels interface is used to upload video and image from Camera to Gateway. An OpenHome camera when deployed without an associated Premise Gateway must support all four interfaces described above.

2.3 Deployment Mode and Interface Requirements

Premise Gateway Off-Premise Gateway Deployment Mode Deployment Mode Interfaces Mandatory Optional Mandatory Optional Local Bootstrap ✓ ✓ Procedures Off-Premise Bootstrap ✓ ✓ Procedures HTTPS Command/ ✓ ✓ Notification XMPP Command/ ✓ ✓ Notification Secure Media Streaming ✓ ✓ Channels Media Upload Channels ✓ ✓

3 Camera and Gateway Prerequisites

3.1 Camera Prerequisites

Camera should support all mandatory features described in the iControl OpenHome Camera Requirements Matrix document. Furthermore, depending on the deployment mode supported, this document assumes the following parameters are pre-configured for each Camera:

Camera Prerequisites for On-Premise Gateway Deployment Mode

1. Serial Number—each camera is pre-configured with a unique 12+ digit alpha/numeric number. Serial number is determined by the camera manufacturer.

2. iControl root Certificate Authority (CA) certificates—each camera is pre-configured with a list of root CA certificates provided by iControl

3. Camera supports TLS v1.0 outbound connection per RFC 2246 (TLS Protocol Version 1.0)

-   -   a. Camera supports TLS host name verification—certificate         received over TLS must match hostname Camera is sending.         Wildcard certificate must be supported.     -   b. Camera supports TLS with AES 128 or AES 256 encryption.

4. Adminstrator account username and password—each camera is pre-configured with a pre-defined administrator username/password (e.g., Administrator/password).

5. UPnP USN—each camera is pre-configured with a pre-defined Universal Plug and Play (UPnP) Unique Service Number (USN) specified by iControl to be used as part of Simple Service Discovery Protocol (SSDP) discovery procedures.

6. HTTP server mode is enabled to listen on port 80

Camera Prerequisites for Off-Premise Gateway Deployment Mode

1. Serial Number—each camera is pre-configured with a unique alpha/numeric number. Serial number is determined by the camera manufacturer and is recommended to be at least 12 digits in length.

2. iControl root Certificate Authority (CA) certificates—each camera is pre-configured with a list of root CA certificates provided by iControl

3. Camera supports TLS v1.0 outbound connection per RFC 2246 (TLS Protocol Version 1.0)

-   -   a. Camera supports TLS host name verification—certificate         received over TLS must match hostname Camera is sending.         Wildcard certificate must be supported.     -   b. Camera supports TLS with AES 128 or AES 256 encryption.

4. Activation Key—each camera is pre-configured with a unique 20-digit alpha/numeric activation key. Activation Key can be stored within the camera's static storage or can be generated on demand at the Camera by using a camera's Serial Number and a manufacturer defined master key. See Appendex C—Activation key Derivation Procedures for a description of the algorithm for calculating activation key from a Camera's serial number.

5. Registry Gateway URL—each camera is pre-configured with an URL provided by iControl

3.2 Camera Optimal WiFi AP/Repeater Selection

For deployment scenarios where WiFi repeaters are utilized or multiple WiFI APs shared the same SSID, a Camera shall periodically compare received signal strengths of all candidate AP/repeaters, and under the right conditions, re-establish connection to the WiFi AP/repeater with the best signal quality. General guidelines for this feature include:

Camera shall periodically compare RSSI signal strengths from all possible BSSIDs serving the same SSID in use by the Camera. Time interval between checks is governed by check interval.

If Camera detects alternate AP(s)/repeater(s) with received RSSI that is higher than existing connection by the switch threshold, the Camera shall disconnect from the current BSSID and re-establish connection with the AP/repeater with the higher signal strength. Re-establishment may be postponed until end of media streaming or upload session.

Switching hysterisys—Once switched from one BSSI to another, Camera shall not switch sooner than min switch time.

Check interval, switch threshold, and min switch time are all configurable parameters that can be managed via /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/<ID>/wireless resource.

3.3 Gateway Prerequisites

The iControl Gateway (including Premise Gateway, Session Gateway, Credential Gateway, Registry Gateway, etc.) should support all mandatory resources/services required by the Camera in order process Commands or Notifications. For example, if a Gateway sends a Command to a Camera that includes mandatory URL for upload, notification, etc., the Gateway must support the specified services when accessed via the URL. At the same time, if a Gateway did not configure a Camera with an upload resource URL, the Camera cannot assume the upload service is available at the Gateway. For example, if no event trigger notifications are enabled at the Camera, the Camera cannot assume the upload Gateway resource will be available.

4 Communication Interface Detail Specifications

Each of the interface types above is described in more detail in the following subsections. The Local Bootstrap Procedures and the Off-Premise Bootstrap Procedures are described in Appendices A and B, respectively.

4.1 Interface Type 1—HTTPS or XMPP Command/Notification Channel

The Command/Notification channel is a bi-directional, asynchronous communication interface that allows for Gateway to send commands to the Camera or for Camera to send Notification Events to the Gateway. There are 2 sub-types of Interface Type 1—XMPP or HTTPS based Command/Notification Channel. The XMPP type, type 1A, uses XMPP as the underlying transport protocol, whereas the HTTPS type, type 1B, relies on HTTPS as the transport protocol. For most applications, only one of the two interface sub-types is required. Each of the two sub-types is described in more detail below. Henceforth in this document, Commands refer to Gateway originated commands from Gateway to Camera, and Notifications refer to Camera originated notifications from Camera to Gateway. Interface Type 1B can only be used if the Premise Gateway is deployed at the same premise as the Camera, whereas Interface Type 1A can be utilized independent of where the Premise Gateway is deployed.

4.1.1 Interface Type 1A—XMPP Command/Notification Channel

The XMPP Command/Notification channel is a bi-directional, asynchronous communication interface that allows for Gateway to send commands to the Camera or for Camera to send Notification Events to the Gateway. This persistent channel is implemented using the XMPP protocol as described in RFC 6120 (Extensible Messaging and Presence Protocol: Core) as the underlying transport, and utilizing messages compliant with iControl's XML stanzas syntax to convey commands and notifications. The iControl XML stanza is a XML wrapper around HTTP-like request/response messages. Detailed definitions of Command and Notifications messages along with their parameters are described in later sections.

A typical channel establishment/disconnect process is described below:

1. Camera receives Session Gateway hostname and port from Credential Gateway per Appendix B—Off-Premise Bootstrap Procedures.

2. Camera opens a TCP connection to Session Gateway (may need to resolve IP address using DNS)

3. Negotiate TLS encryption between Camera and Gateway using Gateway SSL certificates pre-configured in the Camera. Note, no client certificate is required (includes opening 2 XML streams to start TLS negotiation).

4. Open XML streams (one from Camera to Gateway, the other the reverse direction) by sending XMPP XML stream headers.

5. Authenticate using XMPP's SASL (Simple Authentication and Security Layer) using <Serial Number>, <siteID>, and <SharedSecret>. <Serial Number>_<siteID> is used as the Simple Username format.

6. Exchange iControl compliant XML stanzas between Camera and Gateway

-   -   a. Upon receiving a Command stanza, the Camera executes task(s)         specified in the received Commands and reply with status         message. If a Command requires asynchronous execution, the         Camera should execute tasks after initial response and sends         Notifications to Gateway (if required).     -   b. For Notification stanzas, the Gateway takes appropriate         actions and sends acknowledgements.

7. Close XML streams

8. Close TCP connection

4.1.1.1 iControl XMPP Usage Clarifications

The iControl Command/Notification Channel conforms to the XMPP standard with the following further clarifications:

1. Client address—<Serial Number>_<siteID>@<XMPP host>/<siteID> will be used as the client address (e.g., Jabber ID). Where <Serial Number> is embedded in the Camera, <siteID> is derived via Bootstrap Procedures, and <XMPP host> is defined in /OpenHome/System/XMPP/Gateway.

2. Password used in SASL—<SharedSecret> derived via Bootstrap Procedures and will be used as the SASL client password.

3. TLS encryption—Camera must support XMPP TLS encryption mode

4. SASL authentication—Camera must support SASL authentication using client address and credential supplied by the Gateway.

5. XML Streams—2 unidirectional XMPP XML streams will be used over the same TCP connection. One stream from Camera to Gateway and the other from Gateway to Camera.

6. XML Stanzas—Only the <iq> stanza type will be used

7. Reconnection (section 3.3)—Camera backoff wait should exponentially increase per XMPP standard section 3.3, but maximum delay should not be greater than <maxMediaUploadWaitDuration>

8. Others clarifications will be provided in a future version of this document

4.1.1.2 iControl XMPP XML Stanzas Definition

Command and Notification request and response messages are sent using the following XML, stanza schema:

TABLE 1 iControl XMPP XML Stanza Schema <xs:schema xmlns:xs=“http://www.w3.org/2001/XMLSchema” targetNamespace=“http://icontrol.com/http-tunnel/v1” xmlns:smap=“http://icontrol.com/http-tunnel/v1” elementFormDefault=“qualified” attributeFormDefault=“unqualified”> <xs:annotation> <xs:documentation> This schema defines data types in the HTTP Tunnel request/response (used for XMPP, Gateway passthru, etc). The primary purpose is to facilitate complex type binding between the XML data and native objects such as JavaBeans. </xs:documentation> </xs:annotation> <xs:complexType name=“arg”> <xs:simpleContent> <xs:extension base=“xs:string”> <xs:attribute name=“name” type=“xs:string” use=“required”/> </xs:extension> </xs:simpleContent> </xs:complexType> <xs:complexType name=“body” mixed=“true”> <xs:sequence> <xs:any namespace=“##any” processContents=“lax” minOccurs=“0”/> </xs:sequence> <xs:attribute name=“encoded” type=“xs:string” use=“optional”/> </xs:complexType> <xs:complexType name=“http-tunnel”> <xs:sequence> <xs:choice> <xs:element name=“request” type=“request” minOccurs=“0” maxOccurs=“1” /> <xs:element name=“request” type=“response” minOccurs=“0” maxOccurs=“1” /> </xs:choice> </xs:sequence> </xs:complexType> <xs:complexType name=“request”> <xs:sequence> <xs:element name=“header” type=“arg” minOccurs=“0” maxOccurs=“unbounded”/> <xs:element name=“param” type=“arg” minOccurs=“0” maxOccurs=“unbounded”/> <xs:element name=“body” type=“body” minOccurs=“0” maxOccurs=“1”/> </xs:sequence> <xs:attribute name=“action” type=“xs:<CommandURL> | <NotificationURL>” use=“required”/> <xs:attribute name=“method” type=“xs:string” use=“required”/> </xs:complexType> <xs:complexType name=“response”> <xs:sequence> <xs:element name=“header” type=“arg” minOccurs=“0” maxOccurs=“unbounded”/> <xs:element name=“body” type=“body”/> </xs:sequence> <xs:attribute name=“code” type=“xs:int” use=“required”/> </xs:complexType> </xs:schema>

Table 1—iControl XMPP XML Stanza Schema

-   -   This XML stanza schema allows HTTP-type requests and responses         to be tunneled across a XMPP channel. <CommandURL> and         <NotificationURL> are defined in the Command/Notification Data         Types Section. The “method” attribute reflects HTTP methods such         as GET, POST, PUT, DELETE, etc. and are defined by the specific         <CommandURI> or <NotificationURI> types. HTTP request headers         can vary among different Commands and Notifications; these         headers can be enumerated using one or more “header” elements in         the stanza.

4.1.1.3 Example XML Stanzas

The example below illustrates a Command from Gateway to set wireless configurations for the Camera's network interface 1. See Section 5.4.4 for URI and XML definitions.

Gateway −> Camera <iq type=″set″ id=″1234567″ from=″00d022111234_006035123456@gsess.icontrol.com/006035123456″> <http-tunnel xmlns=″http://icontrol.com/http-tunnel/v1″> <request method=″GET″  action=″/System/Network/interfaces/1/wireless″>  <header name=″Host″>192.168.2.52</header>  <header name=″Authorization″>Basic tWNgOGdla0Y6bG5IMXdQQ2g=</header>  <headername=″Pragma″>no-cache</header>  <headername=″Cache-Control″>no-cache</header>  <header name=″Date″>Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT</header>  <body name=″body″></body > </request> </http-tunnel> </iq> Camera −> Gateway <iq type=″result″ id=″1234567″ to=″00d022111234_006035123456@gsess.icontrol.com/006035123456″> <http-tunnel xmlns=″http://icontrol.com/http-tunnel/v1″> <response code=″200″> <header name=″Content-Type″>application/xml; charset=“UTF-8”</header> <header name=″Content-length″><size of the xml body below in bytes></header>  <body name=″body″>   <Wireless version=”1.0” xmlns=”urn:icontrol.com/openhome/v1”>    <enabled>true</enabled>    <wirelessNetworkMode>infrastructure</wirelessNetworkMode>    <ssid>iHub_00622011211</ssid>    <WirelessSecurity>     <securityMode>WPA2-personal</securityMode>     <WPA>      <algorithmType>AES</algorithmType>      <sharedKey>mySecretKey</sharedKey>     </WPA>    </WirelessSecurity>   </Wireless>  </body> </response> </http-tunnel> </iq>

4.1.2 Interface Type 1B—HTTP/HTTPS Command/Notification Channel

The HTTP/HTTPS Command/Notification channel is a bi-directional, asynchronous communication interface that allows for Premise Gateway to send commands to the Camera or for Camera to send Notification Events to the Premise Gateway. The purpose of this interface is similar to the XMPP Command/Notification Channel sub-type, except the underlying transport protocol is HTTP/HTTPS instead of XMPP. Multiple messages can be sent over each connection due to the use of HTTP 1.1 persistent connection (RFC 2616). However, Unlike XMPP, HTTP/HTTPS (even with the use of HTTP 1.1 persistent option) may terminate a connection after an extended idle period. It is the responsibility of the initiating entity (either Camera or Premise Gateway) to re-establish a new connection when a new message is to be delivered. Detailed definitions of Command and Notifications messages along with their parameters are described in Section 5. This section describes the HTTPS transport used to send/receive these messages.

Commands are always send from Gateway to Camera via inbound HTTP/HTTPS connections to the Camera.

Notifications can be delivered from Camera to Gateway via either 1) Camera outbound HTTPS connection or 2) Camera inbound polling via the “/OpenHome/System/Poll/notifications” retrieval Command.

A typical Command/response process is described below:

Pre-requisites:

-   -   Camera was updated with a valid server SSL certificate per         Section 5.7.1.

Gateway Originated Command Channel Setup Process:

1. Gateway opens a TCP connection to Camera

2. Negotiate TLS encryption between Camera and Gateway using Camera's server SSL certificates configured per Section 5.7.1.

3. Gateway sends HTTPS requests to Camera using HTTPS method and URI specific to each Command

4. Camera authenticates request using digest authentication

5. Camera processes received Command via the following sub-steps

-   -   a. Camera executes task(s) specified in the received Command(s).         For Commands that require asynchronous execution, Camera should         execute tasks after step b.     -   b. Camera sends a response message to Gateway using HTTP         response procedures

6. The TCP/TLS connection is kept open for a pre-set duration due to the use of HTTP 1.1 persistent connection option.

7. If connection is idle for a pre-set duration, Close TCP connection

Camera Originated Outbound Notification Channel Setup Process:

1. Camera opens a TCP connection to Gateway

2. Negotiate TLS encryption between Camera and Gateway using Gateway's server SSL certificates. Camera must utilize TLS host name verification while establishing connection.

3. Camera sends HTTPS requests to Gateway using HTTPS method and URI specific to each Notification

4. Gateway authenticates request using digest authentication

5. Gateway processes received Notification via the following sub-steps

-   -   a. Gateway executes task(s) specified in the received         Notification(s).     -   b. Gateway sends a response message to Gateway using HTTP         response procedures

6. The TCP/TLS connection is kept open for a pre-set duration due to the use of HTTP 1.1 persistent connection option.

7. If connection is idle for a pre-set duration, Close TCP connection

Camera Notification via Inbound Polling Process:

In lieu of using Outbound Notification Channel, Notifications can be delivered to Gateway via Inbound Polling. The following is a typical delivery process:

1. Gateway opens a TCP connection to Camera

2. Negotiate TLS encryption between Camera and Gateway using Camera's server SSL certificates configured per Section 5.7.1.

3. Gateway sends /OpenHome/System/Poll/notifications request to Camera

4. Camera waits for new Notification(s) to arrive

5. If a Notification does not arrive before <linger> time expiration, Camera responds with 200 OK with XML body that does NOT contain any Notification

6. If one or more Notification arrive before <linger> time expiration, Camera responds with 200 OK including XML body containing one more more Notifications

7. Upon receiving 200 OK, Gateway repeats loop starting with Step 3

4.1.2.1 Gateway Originated Commands

To issue a Gateway originated command, Gateway initiates HTTP/HTTPS connection to Camera via method and URI <CommandURI> specified by the Command (see Section 5 Command/Notification Data Types). HTTP 1.1 persistent connection mode should be utilized in order to optimize connection usage. Only accounts with administration rights can issue Commands the Camera, with the only exception being that User accounts can access video streaming and picture snapshot.

TABLE 2 HTTPS Command/Notification Channel Setup Message Format Purpose Sends Command to Camera Message Format HTTPS <CommandURI> HTTP/1.1 Authentication Digest authentication using a valid Camera user or admin credential (see /OpenHome/Security/AAA/ accounts for Camera user/admin accounts) Mandatory Authorization Request Headers Mandatory Content-Type, Connection, Content-Length Response Headers Request Body Varies depending on command, see Section 5. Camera Varies depending on command, see Section 5. response Response body Varies depending on command, see Section 5. Variables CommandURI Method and URI Varies depending on command, see Section 5. accountCredential Base64 encoding of (<adminUser>:<password>), where <adminUser> and <password> are defined in /OpenHome/Security/AAA/accounts.

4.1.2.2 Camera Originated Notifications

For Interface Type 1B (HTTPS Command/Notification Channel), Notifications can be delivered from Camera to Gateway via either 1) Camera outbound HTTPS connection or 2) Camera inbound polling via the “/OpenHome/System/Poll/notifications” retrieval Command (Note, the third delivery method, using XMPP Camera-to-Gateway channel, is utilized only in the XMPP Command/Notification Channel). Depending on the configuration of the notification URL parameter, the Camera delivers Notifications using one of the three methods above. For example, the following Notification URL specifies using the Camera outbound HTTPS Notification method:

https://gateway.icontrol.com/<eventAlertURL>

whereas, the following Notification URL specifies using Camera inbound polling for Notification delivery.

poll://<eventAlertURL>

Each of the two Notification delivery types is described in more detail below.

4.1.2.2.1 Camera Originated Outbound Notifications

To initiate a Camera originated outbound Notification, Camera starts HTTP/HTTPS connection to Gateway via method and URI <NotificationURI> specified by the Notification (see Section 5.). HTTP 1.1 persistent connections should be utilized in order to optimize connection usage. The following request format is used:

TABLE 3 Camera Originated Outbound Notification Message Format Purpose Sends Notification to Gateway Message HTTPS <NotificationURI> HTTP/1.1 Formats or HTTP <NotificationURI> HTTP/1.1 Note: only one Command utilizes the non-secure HTTP mode (see Section 5.) Authentication Digest authentication using <SerialNumber> and <SharedSecret> Mandatory Host, Authorization Request Pragma: no-cache, Cache-Control: no-cache, Date Headers Mandatory Content-Type, Connection, Content-Length Response Headers Request Body Varies depending on command, see Section 5. Camera Varies depending on command, see Section 5. response Variables NotificationURI Method and URI Varies depending on command, see Section 5. basicCredential Base64 encoding of (<SerialNumber>:<SharedSecret>), where <SerialNumber> and <SharedSecret> are defined in Section 5.

4.1.2.2.2 Notifications via Inbound Polling

If specified in the Notification URL (e.g., poll://<url>), Camera will queue Notifications for retrieval by the Gateway instead of sending Notifications via outbound HTTP/HTTPS connections. The “/OpenHome/System/Poll/notifications” Command is used to establish a connection from Gateway to Camera for polling Notifications. In this mode, Gateway will establish a semi-persistent HTTP/HTTPS connection to the Camera and wait (or linger) for Notification events. Upon receiving the /OpenHome/Sytem/Poll/notifications Command from the Gateway, if the Camera has Notification events available, it will respond with 200 OK containing Notifications right away. However, if no Notification is pending, the Camera will wait for a Notification or until the <linger> duration has expired before responding with 200 OK. Upon receiving a 200 OK response, the Gateway will issue another /OpenHome/Sytem/Poll/notifications Command to poll for new Notifications. Due to the use of HTTP 1.1 persistent connection, more than one request-response sequences may be sent over a single underlying TCP connection.

4.1.2.3 Examples

Gateway Originated Command

The example below illustrates a Command from Gateway to retrieve wireless configurations for the Camera's network interface 1. See Section 5.4.4 for URI and XML definitions.

Gateway−>Camera GET /System/Network/interfaces/1/wireless HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT Camera−>Gateway HTTP/1.1 401 Unauthorized Host: 192.168.1.50 Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:60 GMT WWW-Authenticate: Digest realm=″Administrator@192.168.1.50″, qop=″auth,auth-int″, nonce=″dcd98b7102dd2f0e8b11d0f600bfb0c093″, opaque=″5ccc069c403ebaf9f0171e9517f40e41″ Gateway−>Camera GET /System/Network/interfaces/1/wireless HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT Authorization: Digest username=″<SerialNumber>″, realm=″ mediagw@ server.icontrol.com″,nonce=″dcd98b7102dd2f0e8b11d0f600bfb0c093″, uri=”/vidupload/icamera/1308677301445/43/f/889229dcd864691ffcd4bff342153a00/″, qop=auth, nc=00000001, cnonce=″0a4f113b″, response=″6629fae49393a05397450978507c4ef1″, opaque=″5ccc069c403ebaf9f0171e9517f40e41″ Camera−>Gateway HTTP/1.1 200 OK Content-Type: application/xml; charset=“UTF-8” Connection: Keep-Alive Content-Length: <size of the xml body below in bytes> <Wireless version=”1.0”> <enabled>true</enabled> <wirelessNetworkMode>infrastructure</wirelessNetworkMode> <ssid>iHub_00622011211</ssid> <WirelessSecurity> <securityMode>WPA2-personal</securityMode> <WPA> <algorithmType>AES</algorithmType> <sharedKey>mySecretKey</sharedKey> </WPA> </WirelessSecurity> </Wireless>

Camera Originated Outbound Notification

The following example illustrates a Notification from Camera indicating a motion event.

Camera−>Gateway POST /gateway.icontrol.com/GWServices/EventAlert/1308677301445/43/f/889229dcd864691ff cd4bff342153a00/ HTTP/1.1 Host: gateway.icontrol.com Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT ... Gateway −>Camera HTTP/1.1 401 Unauthorized Host: server.icontrol.com Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:60 GMT WWW-Authenticate: Digest realm=″mediagw@gateway.icontrol.com″, qop=″auth,auth-int″, nonce=″dcd98b7102dd2f0e8b11d0f600bfb0c093″, opaque=″5ccc069c403ebaf9f0171e9517f40e41″ Camera−>Gateway POST /gateway.icontrol.com/GWServices/EventAlert/1308677301445/43/f/889229dcd864691ff cd4bff342153a00/ HTTP/1.1 Host: gateway.icontrol.com Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT Content-Type: application/xml; charset=“UTF-8” Authorization: Digest username=″<SerialNumber>″, realm=″ mediagw@ server.icontrol.com″,nonce=″dcd98b7102dd2f0e8b11d0f600bfb0c093″, uri=”/gateway.icontrol.com/GWServices/EventAlert/1308677301445/43/f/88922 9dcd864691ffcd4bff342153a00/″, qop=auth, nc=00000001, cnonce=″0a4f113b″, response=″6629fae49393a05397450978507c4ef1″, opaque=″5ccc069c403ebaf9f0171e9517f40e41″ Content-Length: <size of the xml body below in bytes> <EventAlert version=”1.0”> <id>23XZ0933</id> <dateTime>2009-03-11T15.5:27Z</dateTime > <activePostCount>301</activePostCount> <eventType>PirMD</eventType> <eventState>active</eventState> <eventDescription>PIR motion detected</eventDescription> </EventAlert> Gateway−>Camera HTTP/1.1 200 OK Connection: Keep-Alive

Camera Notification via Inbound Polling

The following example illustrates a motion event Notification from Camera that is delivered to the Gateway via inbound polling.

Gateway−>Camera GET /OpenHome/System/poll/notifications/poll?linger=120 HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 Gateway −>Camera HTTP/1.1 401 Unauthorized Host: server.icontrol.com Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:60 GMT WWW-Authenticate: Digest realm=“mediagw@gateway.icontrol.com ”, qop=“auth,auth-int”, nonce=“dcd98b7102dd2f0e8b11d0f600bfb0c093”, opaque=“5ccc069c403ebaf9f0171e9517f40e41” Gateway−>Camera GET /OpenHome/System/poll/notifications/poll?linger=120 HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 Authorization: Digest username=“<SerialNumber>”, realm=“ mediagw@ server.icontrol.com”,nonce=“dcd98b7102dd2f0e8b11d0f600bfb0c093”, uri/OpenHome/System/poll/notifications/poll”, qop=auth, nc=00000001, cnonce=“0a4f113b”, response=“6629fae49393a05397450978507c4ef1”, opaque=“5ccc069c403ebaf9f0171e9517f40e41”

After 120 Seconds without Notification

  Camera−>Gateway HTTP/1.1 200 OK Content-Type: application/xml; charset=“UTF-8” Connection: Keep-Alive Content-Length: <size of the xml body below in bytes>

As Soon as Gateway Received and Processed the 200 OK Message

Gateway−>Camera GET /OpenHome/System/poll/notifications/poll?linger=120 HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 Gateway −>Camera HTTP/1.1 401 Unauthorized Host: server.icontrol.com Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:24:60 GMT WWW-Authenticate: Digest <digest challenge> Gateway−>Camera GET /OpenHome/System/poll/notifications/poll?linger=120 HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 Authorization: Digest <challenge response> Camera−>Gateway HTTP/1.1 200 OK Content-Type: application/xml; charset=“UTF-8” Connection: Keep-Alive Content-Length: <size of the xml body below in bytes> <NotificationWrapper> <notificationURI>/gateway.icontrol.com/GWServices/EventAlert/130867730144 5/43/f/889229dcd864691ffcd4bff342153a00 </notificationURI> <notifyTime>2009-03-11T15:27.5Z</notifyTime> <notifyBody> < EventAlert version=“1.0”> <id>23XZ0933</id> <dateTime>2009-03-11T15:27.4Z</dateTime > <activePostCount>301</activePostCount> <eventType>PirMD</eventType> <eventState>active</eventState> <eventDescription>PIR motion detected</eventDescription> </EventAlert> </notifyBody> </NotificationWrapper>

4.2 Interface Type 2—Secure Streaming Media Channels

Three types of Streaming Media Channels are utilized for secured upload or live streaming of media contents from the Camera to the Gateway.

1. RTSP Streaming Media Channel—used to transport RTSP video from Camera to Gateway

2. MJPEG Streaming Media Channel—used to transport MJPEG video

3. HTTP Live Streaming Media Channel—used to transport HLS video from Camera to Gateway

Each of these three types is described in more detail in subsequent sections. In addition to the three tunneled Media Channel modes, a Camera must also support direct, non-tunneled RTSP, HLS, or MJPEG connections initiated from RTSP/MJPEG/HLS clients. This mode may be used for direct client to camera access over a LAN without the use of an intervening Gateway.

4.2.1 RTSP Media Channel

The RTSP Media Channel is used to tunnel RTSP video over a TLS connection between the Camera and the Gateway. Upon receiving a Gateway originated Command (which is sent over the Command-Notification Channel), the Camera establishes a RTSP Media Channel connection to the Gateway via the following procedures:

1. Camera receives /Streaming/MediaTunnel/create command from Gateway (could be On-Premise or Off-Premise Gateway) with the following parameters: <relayGatewayAddress>, <sessionID>, <requestType>, <cameraType>, <sessionPassword>

2. Camera initiates a TLS connection to Session Gateway at <sessionGatewayAddress>. This step may require a DNS lookup for IP address based on the hostname.

3. Camera and Session Gateway complete TLS negotiation per RFC 2246 (TLS Protocol Version 1.0). Camera must utilize TLS host name verification while establishing connection.

4. Camera sends a HTTP POST request to Session Gateway in accordance with Table 4 and Table 5 herein.

5. Camera waits for RTSP messages from Session Gateway. If no RTSP message is received after <MaxMediaTunnelReadyWait> timeout, Camera tears down existing TLS connection and restart a new connection per Step 1. An example of <MaxMediaTunnelReadyWait> is 120 seconds.

6. Upon arrival of RTSP message(s) to Camera (usually after an end-user starts a live video session), normal RTSP request-response negation is initiated per RFC 2326 (Real Time Streaming Protocol)

7. RTP/RTCP media streams from Camera to Session Gateway over the existing TLS connection, using RTSP interleaved transport mode per RFC 2326.

8. Camera receives RTSP TEARDOWN from Session Gateway, replies with 200 OK, and then starts to disconnect TLS session with Session Gateway

4.2.1.1 State Transition Diagram

The state transition diagram for the above sequence is illustrated in FIG. 27 , and described in more detail below:

IDLE state represents idle state where no media tunnel needs to be built. START state represents start initiating Media Channel state where the Camera initiates TLS connection with Gateway. Upon entering this state, Camera should increment its number of retries counter and check if it has reached maximum <retries> without successful connection. If maximum <retries> is reached, Camera should return to IDLE state. Before retrying connection, Camera should wait for a delay (e.g., delay equals number of retries*<stepsizeWait>) before starting TLS connection. SOCKET_WAITING state represents waiting for network layer to complete establishing a TLS connection between the Camera and the Gateway. SOCKET_CONNECTED state represents where TLS negoation was successfully completed between the Camera and the Gateway. TUNNEL_READY state represents where the media tunnel is established and the Camera is waiting for a RTSP request from the Gateway. If Camera stays in TUNNEL_READY state for greater than <maxMediaTunnelReadyWait> time, Camera should transition to START state. RTSP_INIT state represents state where the Camera received at least one RTSP DESCRIBE request from the Gateway. RTSP_READY state represents state where the Camera is waiting for RTSP PLAY or additional RTSP SETUP requests. RTSP_PLAYING state represents state where the Camera is streaming media to the Gateway. Camera should resets its number of retry counter to zero. DISCONNECTING state represents state where the Camera is tearing down TLS connection with the Gateway.

4.2.1.2 Sample Call Flows

See FIG. 28 .

4.2.1.3 HTTPS POST Format for Tunnel Creation

Format of HTTPS POST URI from Camera to Gateway is described in more detail below. This request is sent from Camera to Gateway while transitioning from the SOCKET_CONNECTED state to the TUNNEL_READY state.

TABLE 4 Media Channel HTTP POST Format Purpose Establish Media tunnel within a TLS connection Message POST /<GatewayAddress>/<MediaTunnelURI> HTTP/1.1 Format Authentication None in HTTP header (authentication required in RTSP header) Mandatory None Request Headers POST Body One or more tunneled RTSP response messages Response from One or more tunneled RTSP request messages and RTP/RTCP media packets Gateway Error Standard HTTP response codes (e.g., 404) responses Example POST POST URI /1607349153877243391/icamera/sslrelay/1308677301445/889229dcd864691ffcd4b ff342153ad7/ HTTP/1.0

TABLE 5 Media Channel HTTP POST Variables Description Variable Name Format Description/Notes GatewayAddress hostname:port Gateway hostname and port or could be IP address and port. See /OpenHome/Streaming/MediaTunnel/create MediaTunnelURI URI URI used in the Create Tunnel POST. Derived from /OpenHome/Streaming/MediaTunnel/create Command parameter.

4.2.1.4 Example Messages

Precondition: successful TLS negotiation Camera−>Gateway POST /1607349153877243391/icamera/sslrelay/1308677301445/889229dcd864691ffcd4bff342 153ad7/ HTTP/1.1 Gateway−>Camera DESCRIBE rtsp://192.168.2.52:4302/OpenHome/Streaming/channels/2/rtsp RTSP/1.0 CSeq: 1 Accept: application/sdp Accept-Language: en User-Agent: iControl Applet 1.0 Authorization: Basic aWN4OGdla0Y6bG5IMXdQQ2g= Content-Length: 0 Camera−>Gateway RTSP/1.0 200 OK Cseq: 1 Content-Base: rtsp://192.168.2.52:4302/OpenHome/Streaming/channels/2/rtsp Content-Type: application/sdp Content-Length: 405 v=0 o=- 15034 15034 IN IP4 192.168.107.226 s=RTSP Server(MPEG4) - iCamera7FF4BF c=IN IP4 0.0.0.0 t=0 0 a=charset:Shift_JIS a=range:npt=0- a=control:* a=etag:1234567890 m=video 0 RTP/AVP 96 b=AS:512 a=rtpmap:96 MP4V-ES/30000 a=control:trackID=1 a=fmtp:96 profile-level-id=1; config=000001B001000001B509000001000000012000845D4C28A021E0A21F;decode _buf=76800 a=x-framerate:15 a=framerate:15.0 Gateway−>Camera SETUP rtsp://192.168.2.52:4302/ Streaming/channels/2/rtsp/trackID=1 RTSP/1.0 CSeq: 2 Transport: RTP/AVP/TCP;unicast;interleaved=0-1 User-Agent: iControl Applet 1.0 Content-Length: 0 Camera−>Gateway RTSP/1.0 200 OK Cseq: 2 Session: 26;timeout=60 Transport: RTP/AVP/TCP;unicast;interleaved=0-1;ssrc=65d471b5;mode=“PLAY” Gateway−>Camera PLAY rtsp://192.168.2.52:4302/OpenHome/Streaming/channels/2/rtsp RTSP/1.0 Accept-Language: en CSeq: 3 User-Agent: iControl Applet 1.0 Session: 26 Range: npt=0.000000- Content-Length: 0 Camera−>Gateway RTSP/1.0 200 OK Cseq: 3 Session: 26;timeout=60 RTP-Info: url=trackID=1;seq=0;rtptime=0 Range: npt=0- RTCP-Interval: 6000

4.2.1.5 RTSP/RTP/RTCP Usage Clarifications

Camera should support RTSP per RFC 2326 (Real-Time Streaming Protocol) and RTP/RTCP per RFC 3550 (A Transport Protocol for Real-Time Applications). Furthermore, the following usage clarifications are to be followed:

-   -   1. Camera should support RTSP interleaved transport mode per RFC         2326     -   2. Camera should support at the minimum, Basic Authorization per         RFC 2326     -   3. Camera should not require the Gateway to transmit RTCP         packets, since RTCP is optional per RFC 3550

4.2.2 MJPEG Media Channel

The MJPEG Media Channel is used to tunnel MJPEG streams over a TLS connection between the Camera and the Gateway. The MJPEG Media Channel is very similar to the RTSP Media Channel, with the exception that MJPEG streams are transported over the tunnel and RTSP protocol is not used to negotiate a session. Upon receiving the /Streaming/MediaTunnel/create Command (which was sent over the Command-Notification Channel), the Camera establishes a MJPEG Media Channel connection to the Gateway via the following sequence:

1. Camera receives /Streaming/MediaTunnel/create command from Gateway with the following parameters: <relayGatewayAddress>, <sessionID>, <requestType>, <cameraType>, <sessionPassword>

2. Camera initiates a TLS connection to Gateway at <sessionGatewayAddress>, including DNS lookup.

3. Camera and Gateway complete TLS negotiation per RFC 2246 (TLS Protocol Version 1.0). Camera must utilize TLS host name verification while establishing connection.

4. Camera sends a HTTP POST request to Session Gateway in accordance with Table 4 and Table 5 herein.

5. Camera waits for a HTTP GET request from Gateway. If no HTTP GET request is received after <MaxMediaTunnelReadyWait> timeout, Camera tears down existing TLS connection and restart a new connection per Step 1. An example of <MaxMediaTunnelReadyWait> is 120 seconds.

6. Camera sends a stream of MJPEG data to Gateway over the previously established TLS tunnel as part of its 200 OK response. A MJPEG stream consists of one or more JPEG frames separated by a delineating boundary string defined by the Camera.

4.2.2.1 State Transition Diagram

The state transition diagram for the above sequence is illustrated in FIG. 29 and described in detail below:

IDLE state represents idle state where no media tunnel needs to be built. START state represents start initiating Media Channel state where the Camera initiates TLS connection with Gateway. Upon entering this state, Camera should increment its number of retries counter and check if it has reached maximum <retries> without successful connection. If maximum <retries> is reached, Camera should return to IDLE state. Before retrying connection, Camera should wait for a delay (e.g., delay equals number of retries*<stepsizeWait>) before starting TLS connection. SOCKET_WAITING state represents waiting for network layer to complete establishing a TLS connection between the Camera and the Gateway. SOCKET_CONNECTED state represents state where TLS connectivity is established between the Camera and the Gateway. TUNNEL_READY state represents state where the media tunnel is established and the Camera is waiting for a HTTP GET request from the Gateway. If Camera stays in TUNNEL_READY state for greater than <maxMediaTunnelReadyWait> time, Camera should transition to START state. STREAMING state represents state where the Camera has received a valid HTTP GET request and is streaming media to the Gateway. Camera should resets its number of retry counter to zero. DISCONNECTING state represents state where the Camera is tearing down TLS connection with the Gateway.

MJPEG HTTP POST Tunnel Creation Format

Format of HTTPS POST URI from Camera to Gateway is the same the HTTPS POST request format in Section 4.2.1.3.

4.2.2.2 HTTP GET Start MJPEG Streaming Format

Format of HTTP GET URI from Gateway to Camera is described below:

TABLE 6 MJPEG HTTP GET Format Purpose Request by Gateway to start MJPEG streaming. This request is sent when the Gateway wants the Camera to start MJPEG streaming. Message HTTP GET/<MJPEG_Path> HTTP/1.0 Format Authorization: Basic <BasicCredential> Authentication HTTP authorization: Basic Mandatory Authorization Request Headers Response from HTTP/1.0 200 OK Gateway Content-Type: multipart/x-mixed-replace;boundary=<randomString> follow by one or more JPEG frames delineated by: --<randomString> Content-type: image/jpeg\r\n Content-Length: <jpeg image length in bytes>\r\n \r\n <binary JPEG data> Error responses Standard HTTP response codes (e.g., 404) Example GET GE/OpenHome/Streaming/channels/2/http HTTP/1.0 Authorization: Basic aWN4OGdla0Y6bG5IMXdQQ2g=

TABLE 7 MJPEG HTTP GET Variables Variable Name Format Description/Notes MJPEG_Path URI path Path to signaling start MJPEG streaming. This value is read from the Camera. BasicCredential Alpha numeric string Base64 encoding of <username:password> for accessing the camera randomString String Delineator string generated by the Camera used to mark boundaries between JPEG frames within a MJPEG stream

Precondition: successful TLS negotiation Carrier a−> Gateway POST /1607349153877243391/icamera/sslrelay/1308677301445/889229dcd864691ffcd4bff342 153ad7/ HTTP/1.0 Gateway−>Camera GET /OpenHome/Streaming/channel/1/http HTTP/1.1 Authorization: Basic tdNnOGdla0Y6bG5IMXdQQ2g= Camera−>Gateway HTTP/1.0 200 OK Content-Type: multipart/x-mixed-replace;boundary=MyRandomStr --MyRandomStr Content-Type: image/jpeg Content-Length: 22444 <jpeg binary data>

4.2.3 HTTP Live Streaming Media Channel

The HTTP Live Streaming (HLS) Media Channel is used to tunnel HLS streams over a TLS connection between the Camera and the Gateway. The HLS Media Channel is very similar to the RTSP Media Channel, with the exception that HLS streams are transported over the tunnel and HLS request/response protocols are used to transfer media segments. Upon receiving the /Streaming/Media Tunnel/create Command (which was sent over the Command-Notification Channel), the Camera establishes a HLS Media Channel connection to the Gateway via the following sequence:

-   -   7. Camera receives /Streaming/MediaTunnel/create command from         Premise Gateway with the following parameters:         <relayGatewayAddress>, <sessionID>, <requestType>, <cameraType>,         <sessionPassword>     -   8. Camera initiates a TLS connection to Session Gateway at         <sessionGatewayAddress>, including DNS lookup.     -   9. Camera and Session Gateway complete TLS negotiation per RFC         2246 (TLS Protocol Version 1.0). Camera must utilize TLS host         name verification while establishing connection.     -   10. Camera sends a HTTP POST request to Session Gateway in         accordance with Table 4 and Table 5 herein.     -   11. Camera waits for a HTTP GET request from Session Gateway for         retrieving the initial HLS Playlist file. If no HTTP GET request         is received after <MaxMediaTunnelReadyWait> timeout, Camera         tears down existing TLS connection and restart a new connection         per Step 1. An example of <MaxMediaTunnelReadyWait> is 120         seconds.     -   12. Camera sends a HLS Playlist File to Session Gateway over the         previously established TLS tunnel as part of its 200 OK         response.     -   13. Camera waits for one or more HTTP GET request(s) from         Gateway for retrieving HLS media segments or updated HLS         Playlist.     -   14. Camera responds to HTTP GET with HLS media segment or         Playlist.

4.3 Interface Type 3—Media Upload Channels

The Media Upload Channel is used to transport video clips, still frame images, or event notifications from the Camera to the Session Gateway. The Camera utilizes standard HTTPS POST procedures to transfer media content. All media upload channels must utilize secure TLS and digest authentication to encrypt and secure its content. Furthermore, Camera must utilize TLS host name verification while establishing secure connections. Media Upload Channels can be triggered by either a Gateway originated Command (e.g., CaptureVideoClip) or a Camera Originated event (e.g., motion detected, capture video and upload). Three types of Media Upload Channels are defined—1) Video Clip Upload, 2) Image Upload, and 3) event notification. The following subsections describe their specific formats.

4.3.1 Video Clip Upload

Format of Video Clip HTTPS POST from Camera to Gateway is described below:

TABLE 8 Video Clip Upload Request URI format Purpose Upload video clip from Camera to Gateway Server Address <UploadGatewayAddress> Message Format HTTPS POST /<postVideoClipURI> HTTP/1.1 Authentication HTTP Digest Authentication (with <SerialNumber> and <SharedSecret>) Mandatory Host, Content-Length, Content-Type, Date, Authorization Standard Request Headers Mandatory X-Capture-Time: <capturedTimestamp> iControl Request Header POST Body Video clip data Response from Standard HTTP response codes (e.g., 200 OK) Gateway Error responses Standard HTTP response codes (e.g., 404)

TABLE 9 Video Clip Upload variables Variable Name Format Description/Notes UploadGatewayAddress hostname and Hostname and port of Gateway port handling media upload. postVideoClipURI URI Supplied by Gateway in the media upload command capturedTimestamp UTC timestamp Timestamp at the Camera when media's 1^(st) frame was captured

Example Messages

Camera−>Gateway POST /vidupload/icamera/1308677301445/43/f/889229dcd864691ffcd4bff342153a00/ HTTP/1.1 Host: server.icontrol.com Content-Type: video/mp4 Date: Sat, 11 Jim 2011 18:23:51 GMT X-Capture-Time: 1308677301225 ... Gateway −>Camera HTTP/1.1 401 Unauthorized Host: server.icontrol.com Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:60 GMT WWW-Authenticate: Digest realm=″mediagw@ server.icontrol.com″, qop=″auth,auth-int″, nonce=″dcd98b7102dd2f0e8b11d0f600bft0c093″, opaque=″5ccc069c403ebaf9f0171e9517f40e41″ Camera−>Gateway POST /vidupload/icamera/1308677301445/43/f/889229dcd864691ffcd4bff342153a00/ HTTP/1.1 Host: server.icontrol.com Content-Type: video/mp4 Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT X-Capture-Time: 1308677301225 Authorization: Digest username=″<SerialNumber>″, realm=″ mediagw@ server.icontrol.com″,nonce=″dcd98b7102dd2f0e8b11d0f600bfb0c093″, uri=”/vidupload/icamera/1308677301445/43/f/889229dcd864691ffcd4bff342153a 00/″, qop=auth, nc=00000001, cnonce=″0a4f113b″, response=″6629fae49393a05397450978507c4ef1″, opaque=″5ccc069c403ebaf9f0171e9517f40e41″ Content-Length: 144555 <mp4 binary content> Gateway −>Camera HTTP/1.1 200 OK

4.3.2 Image Upload

Format of Image HTTPS POST is described below:

TABLE 10 Image Upload Request URI format Purpose Upload still image from Camera to Gateway Server Address <UploadGatewayAddress> Message Format HTTPS POST /<postImageURI> HTTP/1.1 Authentication HTTP Digest (with <SerialNumber> and <SharedSecret>) Mandatory Host, Content-Length, Content-Type (image/jpeg), Date, Authorization Standard Request Headers Mandatory X-Capture-Time: <capturedTimestamp> Custom Request Header POST Body Image data Response from Standard HTTP response codes (e.g., 200 OK) Gateway Error responses Standard HTTP response codes (e.g., 404)

TABLE 11 Image Upload variables Variable Name Format Description/Notes UploadGatewayAddress hostname and Hostname and port of Gateway port handling media upload. postImageURI URI Supplied by Gateway in the media upload command capturedTimestamp UTC timestamp Timestamp at the Camera when image was captured

4.3.3 Event Notification Upload

Format of Event Notification HTTPS POST is described below:

TABLE 12 Event Notification Request URI format Purpose Upload event notifications from Camera to Gateway Server Address <UploadGatewayAddress> Message Format HTTPS POST /<eventNotifyURI> HTTP/1.1 Authroziation: Basic <basicCredential> Authentication HTTP Digest Authentication (with <SerialNumber> and <SharedSecret>) Mandatory Host, Content-Length, Content-Type (application/xml), Date, Authorization Standard Request Headers Mandatory X-Capture-Time: <capturedTimestamp> Custom Request Header POST Body XML Body Response from Standard HTTP response codes (e.g., 200 OK) Gateway Error responses Standard HTTP response codes (e.g., 404)

TABLE 13 Event Notification variables Variable Name Format Description/Notes UploadGatewayAddress hostname Hostname and port of Gateway and port handling event notification. eventNotifyURI URI Supplied by Gateway capturedTimestamp UTC Timestamp at the Camera when timestamp event occured

4.3.4 Media Upload Under Error Conditions

If error is encountered during a Video or Image Upload procedure, the Camera is responsible for re-initiating the upload procedure up to <retries> times. Upon initial failure, the Camera should wait for a random delay between <minWait> and <stepsizeWait>. Each subsequent retry attempt should backup increasingly (preferably exponentially) using industry standard practices such as “truncated binary exponential backoff”, or using a multiple of <stepsizeWait>), up to maximum delay of <maxWait>. If Camera is still unable to upload media after <maxMediaUploadRetries>, Camera should send a MediaUploadFailure Notification event to the Gateway via HTTPS or XMPP Command/Notification Channel.

Example simple backoff timer calculations

First connection retry wait time=random(0−<stepsizeWait>)

Subsequent retry wait time=max(<maxWait>, #reRetryCount*<stepsizeWait>)

5 Command/Notification Data Types

The following tables list Commands and Notifications request and responses that can be transmitted over either the XMPP Command/Notification Channel or the HTTPS Command/Notification Channel. All Commands and Notifications requests should be responded to as soon as possible and the receiving device should not block the channel from receiving additional requests.

XML Data Blocks described in this document contains annotations that describe the properties of the field. For a complete definition, see the XML schema definitions. The following information is inserted into the comments to describe the data carried in the field:

Annotation Description req Required field. opt Optional field. For data uploaded to the device, if the field is present but the device does not support it, it should be ignored. dep This field is required depending on the value of another field. ro Read-only. For XML data that is both read and written to the device, this field is only present in XML returned from the device. If this field is present in XML uploaded to the device, it should be ignored. wo Write-only. This field is only present in XML that can be uploaded to the device. This field should never be present in data returned from the device. [This is used for uploading passwords]. xs:<type> A type defined in XML Schema Part 2: Datatypes Second Edition, see http://www.w3.org/TR/xmlschema-2

Note that XML structures that are optional may have required fields. This means that the entire XML block is optional, however if it is present the required fields are mandatory.

5.1 Data Type Overview

Many data types defined in this chapter may be similar or have the same characteristics as defined by the Physical Security Interoperability Alliance (PSIA, http://www.psialliance.org). In particular, the PSIA Service Model (Pysical Security Interoperability Alliance Service Model version 1.0, revision 1.2) and the PSIA IPMD (Pysical Security Interoperability Alliance IP Media Device API Specification version 1.1, revision 1) documents define common terminologies and data structures used in this Section. However, new service commands and modifications were necessary to PSIA's model in order to support iControl's interface. The following tables summarize similarities and differences between the PSIA and the iControl data models. Columns marked as “Same as PSIA” are Commands that have same XML elements as PSIA, except for XML namespace. Columns marked as “Modified PSIA” are Commands that have similar XML elements as PSIA, but with iControl specific modifications. Columns marked as “New” are Command or Notifications specific to iControl.

Same as Modified REQ System PSIA PSIA New ✓ /OpenHome/api ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/reboot ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/updateFirmware ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/updateFirmware/status ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/ConfigurationData/configFile ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/ConfigurationData/Timers ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/factoryReset ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/deviceInfo ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/time ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/time/localTime ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/time/ntpServers ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/time/ntpServers/<ID> ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/logging ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/logging/logData ✓ ✓ Notification: Logging Event ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/inputs/privacy ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/XMPP/Gateway ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/HTTP/Server ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/history ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/history/configuration ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/Poll/notifications ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/Ping ✓ Same as Modified REQ System/Network PSIA PSIA New ✓ /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/<ID> ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/<ID>/ipAddress ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/<ID>/wireless ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/<ID>/wireless/status ✓ /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/<ID>/ieee802.1x ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/<ID>/discovery ✓ Same as Modified REQ System/Audio or System/Video Input Settings PSIA PSIA New ✓ /OpenHome/System/Audio/channels ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/Audio/channels/<ID> ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/Video/inputs ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/Video/inputs/channels ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/System/Video/inputs/channels/<ID> ✓ Same as Modified REQ Security PSIA PSIA New ✓ /OpenHome/Security/updateSSLCertificate/client ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Security/updateSSLCertificate/server ✓ ✓ Request for updateSSLCertificate ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Security/AAA/accounts ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Security/AAA/accounts/<ID> ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Security/Authorization/ ✓ Same as Modified REQ Streaming PSIA PSIA New ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/channels ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID> ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/capabilities ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/status ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/status ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/rtsp ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/video/upload ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/requestKeyFrame ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/http ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/picture ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/picture/upload ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/hls/playlist ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/hls/<MediaSegment> ✓ ✓ Notification: MediaUploadFailure ✓ Same as Modified REQ MediaTunnel PSIA PSIA New ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/MediaTunnel ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/MediaTunnel/<ID>/status ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/MediaTunnel/create ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Streaming/MediaTunnel/<ID>/destroy ✓ ✓ Notification: CreateMediaTunnelFailure ✓ Same as Modified REQ PTZ PSIA PSIA New /PTZ/channels ✓ /OpenHome/PTZ/channels/<ID> ✓ /OpenHome/PTZ/channels/<ID>/homePosition ✓ /OpenHome/PTZ/chamiels/<ID>/relative ✓ /OpenHome/PTZ/channels/<ID>/absolute ✓ /OpenHome/PTZ/channels/<ID>/status ✓ Same as Modified REQ Detection PSIA PSIA New /OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection/PIR ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection/PIR/<ID> ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection/video ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection/video/<ID> ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection/video/<ID>/capabilities ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/SoundDetection ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/SoundDetection/<ID> ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/TemperatureDetection ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/TemperatureDetection/<ID> ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/TemperatureDetection/<ID>/Current ✓ Same as Modified REQ Events PSIA PSIA New ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/Event ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/Event/triggers ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/Event/triggers/<ID> ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/Event/triggers/<ID>/notifications ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/Event/triggers/<ID>/notifications/<NOTIFYID> ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/Event/notification ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/Event/notification/Host ✓ ✓ /OpenHome/Custom/Event/notification/Host/<ID> ✓ ✓ Notification: Event Alert ✓

5.2 Service Discovery of Camera Resources

Syntax for data type URIs defined in this Section is intended only as a recommendation. A Camera can override specific URIs for resources or add new URIs, if needed. Service discovery of OpenHome Data Type resources and their URLs can be achieved by retrieving (GET) from the following URI:

/OpenHome/api In response, Camera should return the following XML data structure containing all URI resources supported by the device: <api> <resource href=“/OpenHome/System/reboot” methods=“PUT” name=“System/reboot” version=“1.0”/> <resource href=“/OpenHome/System/deviceInfo” methods=“GET,PUT” name=“System/deviceInfo” version=“1.0”/> ... <resource href=“/OpenHome/Streaming/channels/0/picture” methods=“GET” name=“Streaming/channels/0/picture” version=“1.0”/> <resource href=“/OpenHome/Streaming/channels/1/picture” methods=“GET” name=“Streaming/channels/1/picture” version=“1.0”/> ... </api> where <resource> delinates a resource available on the Camera ‘href’ attribute defines URI for the particular resource ‘methods’ attribute defines methods supported by the resource in capital letters, separated by comma. ‘name’ attribute provides the resource's name. ‘version’ attribute provides the resource's version number of the service for the resource. <api>, <resource>, and ‘href’, ‘methods’, ‘name’ attributes are all mandatory parameters.

This version of the interface specification does not yet standardize on the resources' names. Future version of this document may define standard resource names in order to facilitate auto-discovery.

5.3 /OpenHome/System Data Type Details

A list of Commands/Notifications and corresponding URIs are is described in the following subsections. The Type field in the table describes whether the URI is a Command or Notification, where a Command is a Gateway originated request and a Notification is a Camera originated request.

5.3.1 ResponseStatus XML Block

The ResponseStatus XML block is used throughout this Section. It is defined as:

ResponseStatus XML Block

<ResponseStatus version=”1.0”> <requestURL> <!-- opt, xs: string --> </requestURL> <statusCode> <!—req, O=1-OK, 2-Device Busy, 3-Device Error, 4-Invalid Operation, 5-Invalid XML Format, 6- Invalid XML Content; 7-Reboot Required--> </statusCode> <statusString> <!-- req, xs:string --> </statusString> <ID> <!-- opt, xs:integer --> </ID> </ResponseStatus >

For Commands that return with an error response, Camera should include <statusString> indicating reason for the failure. This response is particularly important when only a sub-portion of a configuration block encounters error; in such situations, Camera should respond with <statusString> indicating the elements and reason for the error.

Camera should respond with 4-Invalid Operation and set <statusString> to indicate the error, if any portion of the Command is not supported. For example, for a configuration Command, if a Camera supports most of the configuration but not all, Camera should return 4-Invalid Operation with <statusString> indicating which portion of the configuration parameters the Camera deems as not supported.

5.3.2 Camera Configuration Changes

Camera configurations can be read or modified via HTTP/HTTPS access to URIs described in this Section. Unless explicitly specified, all configuration changes (if successful) should take effect immediately within the device before sending <ResponseStatus>. Only the following list of URIs can postpone effective status until after a device reboot:

/OpenHome/System/updateFirmware

/OpenHome/System/ConfigurationData/configFile

/OpenHome/Security/updateSSLCertificate/client

/OpenHome/Security/updateSSLCertificate/server

For reach URI request above, the Camera should respond with “Reboot Required” in the <ResponseStatus> “statusCode” element.

5.3.3 /OpenHome/System/reboot

URI /OpenHome/System/reboot Type Command Function Reboot device Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result PUT <ResponseStatus> Notes The <ResponseStatus> XML data is returned before the device proceeds to reboot.

5.3.4 /OpenHome/System/updateFirmware

URI /OpenHome/System/updateFirmware Type Command Function Update device firmware Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result POST <FirmwareDownLoad> <ResponseStatus> Notes Checksum is the MD5 checksum of the firmware image. Camera should verify MD5 checksum after download before proceeding with firmware upgrade. If successful, device should auto-reboot after upgrade.

FirmwareDownLoad XML Block

<FirmwareDownLoad version=”1.0”>   <url>  <!-- req, xs:string --> </url>   <fwVersion>  <!-- opt, xs:string --> </fwVersion>   <md5checksum> <!-- opt, xs:string --> </md5checksum> </FirmwareDownLoad>

5.3.5 /OpenHome/System/updateFirmware/status

URI /OpenHome/System/ Type Command updateFirmware Function Update device firmware Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <UpdateFirmwareStatus> Notes After successful completion of this API, the <ResponseStatus> XML data is returned, and the device proceeds to reboot. Checksum is the MD5 checksum of the firmware image. Camera should verify MD5 checksum after download before proceeding with firmware upgrade. <updateTime> is in UTC ISO 8601 format.

UpdateFirmwareStatus XML Block

<UpdateFirmwareStatus version=”1.0”>   <updateSuccess> <!-- req, xs:string, “true”, “false” -->   </updateSuccess>   <updateTime>     <!-- req, xs:dateTime of last successful firmware upgrade -->   </updatedTime >   <errorReason> <!-- opt, xs:string , display string for failure-->   </errorReason >   <url> <!-- opt, xs:string -->  </url>   <fwVersion> <!-- opt, xs:string -->  </fwVersion>   <downloadPercentage> <!-- req, xs:integer, 0-100 -->   </   downloadPercentage>   <checksumCheckSuccess> <!-- opt, xs:string, “true”, “false” -->   </checksumCheckSuccess> </UpdateFirmwareStatus >

5.3.6 /OpenHome/System/ConfigurationData/configFile

URI /OpenHome/System/ConfigurationData/ Type Command configFile Function The function is used to get or set a configuration file for the device. This function is used to configure the device with all parameters at once rather than one resource at a time. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <ConfigData> PUT <ConfigData> < ResponseStatus> Notes For PUT operation, device should update its configuration file with the updated info and response with “Boot Required” in <ResponseStatus>. New configuration will take effect upon reboot. ConfigXML contains one or more configurable XML elements defined in this specification. Examples include ConfigTimers, DeviceInfo, Time, etc.

ConfigFile XML Block

<ConfigFile version=“1.0”> <!-- opt, XML elements, one or more configurable XML elements defined in this specification --> </ConfigFile>

5.3.7 /OpenHome/System/ConfigurationData/Timers

URI /OpenHome/System/ConfigurationData/ Type Command Timers Function The function is used to get or set the timer specific configuration data for the device. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <ConfigData> PUT <ConfigData> < ResponseStatus> Notes See MediaTunnel and MediaUpload sections for <maxWait> timer descriptions. <XmppTimers> are similar to MediaUpload timers such that <minWait> is the minimum time to wait in milliseconds before the next retry <maxWait> is the maximum time to wait in milliseconds before the next retry <stepsizeWait> is the stepsize used in exponential backoff. <retries> is the maximum number of retries. If <retries> equals −1, the number of retries is infinite. If error is encountered during an upload or connection procedure, the Camera is responsible for re-initiating the procedure up to <retries> times. Upon initial failure, the Camera should wait for a random delay between <minWait> and <stepsizeWait>. Each subsequent retry attempt should backup increasingly (preferably exponentially) using industry standard practices such as “truncated binary exponential backoff”, or using a multiple of <stepsizeWait>), up to maximum delay of <maxWait>.

ConfigTimers XML Block

<ConfigTimers version=“1.0”> <MediaTunnelReadyTimers> <!-- opt --> <maxMediaTunnelReadyWait> <!-- opt, xs:Integer, in ms --> </maxMediaTunnelReadyWait> <minWait><!-- opt, xs:Integer, in ms --> </minWait> <maxWait> <!- opt, xs:Integer, in ms --> </maxWait> <stepsizeWait> <!-- opt, xs:Integer, in ms --> </stepsizeWait> <retries> <!-- opt, xs:Integer --> </ retries >  </MediaTunnelReadyTimers> <!-- opt --> <MediaUploadTimers> <!-- opt --> <minWait><!-- opt, xs:Integer, in ms --> </minWait> <maxWait> <!-- opt, xs:Integer, in ms --> </maxWait> <stepsizeWait> <!-- opt, xs:Integer, in ms --> </stepsizeWait> <retries> <!-- opt, xs:Integer --> </ retries >  </MediaUploadTimers> <!-- opt --> <XmppTimers> <!-- opt --> <minWait><!-- opt, xs:Integer, in ms --> </minWait> <maxWait> <!-- opt, xs:Integer, in ms --> </maxWait> <stepsizeWait> <!-- opt, xs:Integer, in ms --> </stepsizeWait> <retries> <!-- opt, xs:Integer --> </ retries >  </ XmppTimers > <!-- opt --> </ConfigTimers>

5.3.8 /OpenHome/System/factoryReset

URI /OpenHome/System/factoryReset Type Command Function This function is used to reset the configuration for the device to the factory default. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result PUT Mode <ResponseStatus> Notes Two factory reset modes are supported: “full” resets all device parameters and settings to their factory values. “basic” resets all device parameters and settings except the values in /OpenHome/System/Network, /OpenHome/System/XMPP/gateway, /OpenHome/System/HTTP/server and /OpenHome/Security. The default mode is “full”. The device may be rebooted after it is reset.

/OpenHome/System/deviceInfo

URI /OpenHome/System/deviceInfo Type Command Function This function is used to get or set device information. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <DeviceInfo> PUT <DeviceInfo> <ResponseStatus> Notes Some fields are read-only and may not be set. If these fields are present in the inbound XML block, they are ignored. For the <DeviceInfo> uploaded to the device during a PUT operation, all fields are considered optional and any fields that are not present in the inbound XML are not changed on the device. This allows setting of the fields individually without having to load the entire XML block to the device. <deviceDescription> is a description of the device as defined in RFC1213. <deviceLocation> is the location of the device as defined in RFC1213 <systemContact> is the contact information for the device as defined in RFC1213. <systemObjectID> is the System Object Identifier defined in RFC1213. <apiVersion> is the version of the OpenHome Camera Interface Specification supported

DeviceInfo XML Block

<DeviceInfo version=“1.0”> <deviceName> <!-- req, xs:string --> </deviceName> <deviceDescription> <!-- opt, xs:string --> </deviceDescription> <deviceLocation> <!-- opt. xs:string -->  </deviceLocation> <systemContact> <!-- opt, xs:string -->  </systemContact> <!-- Note: The following are read-only parameters --> <deviceID> <!-- ro, req, xs:string;uuid -->  </deviceID> <model>  <!-- ro, req, xs:string --> </model> <serialNumber>  <!-- ro, req, xs:string --> </serialNumber> <macAddress>  <!-- ro, req, xs:string;--> </macAddress> <firmwareVersion> <!-- ro, req, xs:string -->  </firmwareVersion> <firmwareReleasedDate> <!-- ro,, opt, xs:string-->  </firmwareReleasedDate> <logicVersion>  <!-- ro, opt, xs:string --> </logicVersion> <logicReleasedDate>  <!-- ro, opt, xs:string --> </logicReleasedDate> <bootVersion>  <!-- ro, opt, xs:string --> </bootVersion> <bootReleasedDate>  <!-- ro, opt, xs:string --> </bootReleasedDate> <rescueVersion> <!-- ro, opt, xs:string -->   </rescueVersion> <rescueReleasedDate>  <!-- ro, opt, xs:string --> </rescueReleasedDate> <hardwareVersion>  <!-- ro, opt, xs:string -->  </hardwareVersion> <systemObjectID> <!-- ro, opt, xs:string -->   </systemObjectID> <apiVersion>  <!-- ro, opt, xs:string --> </apiVersion> <battery> <!-- ro, opt, xs:string --> <level> <!-- req, xs:integer, percentage, 0..100 --> </level> <timeRemain> <!-- opt, xs:integer, seconds --> </timeRemain > </battery> </DeviceInfo>

5.3.10 /OpenHome/System/time

URI /OpenHome/System/time Type Command Function Access the device time information. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <Time> PUT timeMode <Time> <ResponseStatus> localTime timeZone Notes If the “localTime” query string with a value is specified, the <Time> XML block is not required as inbound data. If <timeMode> is set to “manual” the <localTime> and <timeZone> fields are required. The <LocalTime> block sets the device time. If <timeMode> is set to “NTP”, only the <timeZone> field is required. The device time is set by synchronizing with NTP.

Time XML Block

<Time version=“1.0”> <timeMode> <!-- req, xs:string, “NTP,manual” --> </timeMode> <localTime> <!-- req, xs:dateime --> </localTime> <timeZone> <!-- req, xs:string, POSIX time zone string; see below --> </timeZone> </Time>

5.3.11 /OpenHome/System/time/localTime

URI /OpenHome/System/time/localTime Type Command Function Access the device local time information. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET ISO 8601 Date-Time String PUT ISO 8601 <ResponseStatus> Date-Time String Notes An ISO 8601 Date/Time string is accepted and returned. If the date/time value has a time zone, the time is converted into the device''s local time zone. If the device time mode is set to “NTP”, setting this value has no effect.

5.3.12 /OpenHome/System/time/timeZone

URI /OpenHome/System/time/timeZone Type Command Function Access the device time zone. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET Time zone string PUT Time zone string <ResponseStatus> Notes Time zones are defined by POSIX 1003.1 section 8.3 time zone notations. Note that the value following the +/− is the amount of time that must be added to the local time to result in UTC. Example: EST + 5EDT01:00:00,M3.2.0/02:00:00,M11.1.0/02:00:00 Defines eastern standard time as “EST” with a GMT − 5 offset. Daylight savings time is called “EDT”, is one hour later and begins on the second Sunday of March at 2am and ends on the first Sunday of November at 2am. CET − 1CEST01:00:00,M3.5.0/02:00:00,M10.5.0/03:00:00 Defines central European time as GMT + 1 with a one-hour daylight savings time (“CEST”) that starts on the last Sunday in March at 2am and ends on the last Sunday in October at 3am.

5.3.13 /OpenHome/System/time/ntpServers

URI /OpenHome/System/time/ntpServers Type Command Function Access the NTP servers configured for the device. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <NTPServerList> PUT <NTPServerList> <ResponseStatus> POST <NTPServer> <ResponseStatus> Notes When the <timeMode> is set to “NTP”, the servers in this list are used to synchronize the device's system time. dateTime is in ISO 8601 Date/Time string format.

NTPServerList XML Block

<NTPServerList version=“1.0”> <NTPServer> <!-- opt --> </NTPServer> </NTPServerList >

5.3.14 /OpenHome/System/time/ntpServers/<ID>

URI /OpenHome/System/time/ntpServers/ID Type Command Function Access an NTP server configured for the device. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <NTPServer> PUT <NTPServer> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes Depending on the value of <addressingFormatType>, either the <hostName> or the IP address fields will be used to locate the NTP server. Use of IPv4 or IPv6 addresses depends on the value of the <ipVersion> field in /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/ID/ipAddress.

NTPServer XML Block

<NTPServer version=“1.0”>  <id> <!-- req, xs:string; id --> </id>  <addressingFormatType> <!-- req, xs:string, “ipaddress,hostname” --> </addressingFormatType>  <hostName> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </hostName>  <ipAddress> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipAddress>  <ipv6Address> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipv6Address>  <portNo> <!-- opt, xs:integer -->  </portNo> </NTPServer >

5.3.15 /OpenHome/System/logging

URI /OpenHome/System/logging Type Command Function This function is used to set or read the logging parameters. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <LoggingConfig> PUT < LoggingConfig > <ResponseStatus> Notes The device maintains a rolling log of <maxEntries> that can be configured and queried. Remote logging may be enabled to send each new log entry to a XMPP or a HTTPS server using /OpenHome/System/logging/messages/event

LoggingConfig XML Block

<LoggingConfig version=“1.0”> <LogTrigger> <!--opt--> <severity> <!-- req, xs:string, Severities are defined in RFC3164 -->  </severity> </LogTrigger> <LocalLog> <!-- opt --> <maxEntries> <!-- req, xs:integer --> </maxEntries> </LocalLog> <remoteLog> <!-- opt --> <xmpp> <!-- opt --> <enabled><!-- req, xs:string, if “true” send each new log entry to XMPP server --></enabled> <url><!-- req, xs:string, destination url --> </url> </xmpp> <https> <!-- opt --> <enabled><!-- req, xs:string, if “true” send each new log entry to HTTPS server --></enabled> <url><!-- req, xs:string, destination url --> </url> </https> <poll> <enabled><!-- req, xs:string, if “true” send each new log entry to XMPP server --></enabled> </poll> </remoteLog > </Logging >

5.3.16 /OpenHome/System/logging/logData

URI /OpenHome/System/logging/logData Type Command Function This function is used to access the message log. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET since (optional) <LogData> Notes Returns a list of messages with timestamp equals to or greater than <since>, where <since> is a UTC string for time in seconds since midnight, Jan. 1, 1970 UTC. If <since> is not specified, return all events contained in the local log file. <logData> is a text object containing 0 or more lines of logging text data. Each logging line should at least contain 1) Date/time of event, 2) severity of event, and 3) event text string.

5.3.17 Notification: Logging Event

URI http or Type Notification https://<ipAddress>:<portNo>/ <loggingEventURL> or xmpp://<ipAddress>:<portNo>/ <loggingEventURL> or poll://<loggingEventURL> Function This function is used by Camera to send logging events to Gateway. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result POST <LogEventList> Notes This Notification is sent only if enabled in LoggingConfig. <loggingEventURL>, <ipAdress>, and <portNo> are derived from /OpenHome/System/logging's <remoteLog/xmpp/url> or via <remoteLog/https/url> element and defines protocol used for Notification. <loggingEventURL> Examples: https://192.168.2.200:5000/Notification/logging/messages/event/006222000122 or xmpp://192.168.2.200:5000/Notification/logging/messages/event/006222000122. or poll://Notification/logging/messages/event/006222000122 dateTime is in ISO 8601 Date/Time string format, including fractions of a second.

LogEventList XML Block

<LogEventList version=“1.0”> <LogEvent> <!-- opt --> <logNo> <!-- req, xs:integer --> </logNo> <dateTime>  <!-- req, xs:datetime -->  </dateTime> <severity> <!-- req, xs:integer, </severity> defined in RFC3164 --> <eventID> <!-- opt, xs:string;id --> </eventID> <message> <!-- req, xs: string --> </message> </LogEvent> </LogEventList >

5.3.18 /OpenHome/System/inputs/privacy

URI /OpenHome/System/inputs/privacy Type Command Function Control device privacy setting across all input channels Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <InputPrivacy> PUT <InputPrivacy> < ResponseStatus> Notes

InputPrivacy XML Block

<InputPrivacy version=“1.0”> <videoInputPrivacy> <!-- req, xs:string, “on”, “off” −> </videoInputPrivacy > <audioInputPrivacy> <!-- opt, xs:string, “on”, “off” −> </audioInputPrivacy > </InputPrivacy >

5.3.19 /OpenHome/System/XMPP/Gateway

URI /OpenHome/System/XMPP/server Type Command Function Control XMPP server info Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <XMPPGateway> PUT < XMPPGateway > < ResponseStatus> Notes If enabled, device should communicate with Gateway via XMPP Command/Notification Channel. If ipAddress and ipv6Address elements are not specified, use DNS to resolve hostname IP address.

XMPPGateway XML Block

<XMPPGateway version=“1.0”> <Enabled> <!-- req, xs:string, “on”, “off” −> </Enabled > <hostname> <!-- req, xs:string, xmpp hostname used in XMPP messages --> <ipAddress> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipAddress> <ipv6Address> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipv6Address> <port> <!-- dep, xs:Integer --> </port> </XMPPGateway >

5.3.20 /OpenHome/System/HTTP/Server

URI /OpenHome/System/HTTP/server Type Command Function Configure Camera's local HTTP server Listing ports Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <HTTPServer> PUT < HTTPServer> < ResponseStatus> Notes If enabled, device should communicate with Gateway via Interface Type 1B-HTTP/HTTPS Command/Notification Channel. <defaultLinger> is the default linger in seconds (see /OpenHome/System/Poll/notifications).

HTTPServer XML Block

<HTTPServer version=“1.0”> <https> <!—opt --> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:string, “true”, “false” −> </enabled > <port> <!-- opt, xs:Integer --> </port> <https> <!—opt --> <http> <!—opt --> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:string, “true”, “false” −> </enabled > <port> <!-- opt, xs:Integer --> </port> <https> <!—opt --> <poll> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:string, “true”, “false” −> </enabled > <defaultLinger> <!-- req, xs:Integer --> </defaultLinger> </poll> </ HTTPServer>

5.3.21 /OpenHome/System/history

URI /OpenHome/System/history Type Command Function Get history of Commands and response status Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET sinceCommand <HistoryList> (optional) sinceNotification (optional) Notes sinceCommand and sinceNotification are in <UTC in milliseconds>, where <UTC in milliseconds> is the time in milliseconds since midnight, Jan. 1, 1970 UTC. If sinceCommand and/or sinceNotification query is used, device should return history entries for Commands or Notification since <UTC in milliseconds>, respectively. If sinceCommand is 0 or missing, all Commands in the device history buffer should be returned. If sinceNotification is 0 or missing, all Notifications in the device history buffer should be returned. <notifyTime> is time when Notification was sent by the device in ISO 8601 Date/Time string format, including fractions of a second. <receivedResponseTime> is time when a response was received by the device in ISO 8601 Date/Time string format, including fractions of a second. <responseCode> is the Gateway response code <xmlBody> is the XML body of the Notification

HistoryList XML Block

<HistoryList version=“1.0”> <CommandHistory> <!—opt --> <NotificationHistory> <!—opt --> </HistoryList>

CommandHistory XML Block

<CommandHistory version=“1.0”> <commandURI>    <!-- req, xs:string, request URI --> </commandURI > <commandRxTime> <!-- req, xs:dateTime --></commandRxTime > <commandExecTime> <!-- opt, xs:dateTime --> </commandExecTime > <responseCode> <!-- req, xs:integer --> </responseCode > </CommandHistory >

NotificationHistory XML Block

<NotificationHistory version=“1.0”> <notificationURI> <!-- req, xs:string, URI --> </notificationURI > <notifyTime> <!-- req, xs:dateTime --> </notifyTime > <receivedResponseTime> <!-- opt, xs:dateTime --> </receivedResponseTime > <responseCode> <!-- req, xs:integer --> </responseCode > <xmlBody> <!—req, XML block of notification body --> </NotificationHistory >

5.3.22 /OpenHome/System/history/configuration

URI /OpenHome/System/history/configuration Type Command Function Configure history events queue size Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <HistoryConfiguration> PUT <HistoryConfiguration> <ResponseStatus> Notes

HistoryConfiguration XML Block

<HistoryConfiguration version=“1.0”> <commandHistorySize> <!-- opt, xs:integer, max num of history entries --> </commandHistorySize > <notificationHistorySize> <!-- opt, xs:integer, max num of history entries --> </notificationHistorySize > </HistoryConfiguration >

5.3.23 /OpenHome/System/Poll/notifications

URI /OpenHome/System/Poll/ Type Command notifications Function Poll for one or more pending Notifications Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET linger <NotificationWrapper> Notes linger is time to wait in seconds before responding to a request (if no notification is available). If a notification is available or becomes available during waiting, a response is sent as soon as possible without waiting for the linger expiration. This resource should be used to retrieve pending Notifications if the Notification event's URL is configured to use ‘poll’ as the prefix protocol (vs. http, https, or xmpp). Only Notifications configured for the poll channel should be returned in the response. For a list of all notifications (including polled notifications), use /OpenHome/System/history.

NotificationWrapper XML Block

<NotificationWrapper version=“1.0”> <notificationURI> <!-- req, xs:string, URI --> </notificationURI > <notifyTime> <!-- req, xs:dateTime --> </notifyTime > <notifyBody> <!—req, XML block of notification body --> </NotificationWrapper >

5.3.24 /OpenHome/System/Ping

URI /OpenHome/System/Ping Type Command Function Poll for one or more pending Notifications Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <ResponseStatus> Notes Used by Gateway to verify connection with Camera. Camera responds with <ResponseStatus> upon receiving GET to this resource.

5.4 /OpenHome/System/Network Data Type Details

5.4.1 /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces

URI /OpenHome/System/Network/ Type Command interfaces Function Access the device network interfaces. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <NetworkInterfaceList> Notes As hardwired system resources, network interfaces cannot be created or destroyed.

NetworkInterfaceList XML Block

<NetworkInterfaceList version=“1.0”> < NetworkInterface/> <!-- req --> </NetworkInterfaceList >

5.4.2 /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/<ID>

URI /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/ Type Command ID Function Access a particular network interface. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <NetworkInterface> PUT <NetworkInterface> <ResponseStatus> Notes A <NetworkInterface> represents a virtual network interface, where each interface can be configured separately with IP address configuration (e.g., static for one interface and dynamic for the other). For example, if a camera supports only 1 physical interface but can be used in wireless or wireline mode, two interfaces should be listed to represent each virtual interface.

NetworkInterface XML Block

<NetworkInterface version=“1.0”> <id> <!-- ro, req, xs:string;id --> </id> <enabled> <!-- ro, req, xs:string; “true” or “false” --></enabled > <IPAddress/> <!-- req --> <Wireless/> <!-- opt --> <IEEE802_1x/> <!-- opt --> <Discovery/> <!-- opt --> </NetworkInterface >

5.4.3 /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/<ID>/ipAddress

URI /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/ Type Command ID/ipAddress Function Access the device network interfaces. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <IPAddress> PUT < IPAddress > <ResponseStatus> Notes If <addressingType> is dynamic, fields below it need not be provided. If <addressingType> is dynamic, a DHCP client is used for the device. If <addressingType> is static the device IP address is configured manually and the gateway and DNS fields are optional. If <addressingType> refers to APIPA, the device IP address is automatically configured without DHCP. In this case the gateway and DNS fields are optional. Use of <ipAddress> or <ipv6Address> in fields is dictated by the <ipVersion> field. If <ipVersion> is “v4” the <ipAddress> fields are used; if <ipVersion> is “v6” the <ipv6Address> fields are used. If <ipVersion> is “dual”, both <ipAddress> and <ipv6Address> fields may be used. <subnetMask> notation is “xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx”. <IPV6Address> is “xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx:xxxx” using CIDR notation.

IPAddress XML Block

<IPAddress version=“1.0”> <ipVersion> <!-- req, xs:string, “v4,v6,dual” --> </ipVersion> <addressingType> <!-- req, xs:string, “static,dynamic,apipa” --> </addressingType> <ipAddress> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipAddress> <subnetMask> <!-- dep, xs:string, subnet mask for IPv4 address --> </subnetMask> <ipv6Address> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipv6Address> <bitMask> <!-- dep, xs:integer, bitmask IPv6 address --> </bitMask> <DefaultGateway> <!-- dep --> <ipAddress> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipAddress> <ipv6Address> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipv6Address> </DefaultGateway> <PrimaryDNS> <!-- dep --> <ipAddress> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipAddress> <ipv6Address> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipv6Address> </PrimaryDNS> <SecondaryDNS> <!-- dep --> <ipAddress> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipAddress> <ipv6Address> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipv6Address> </SecondaryDNS> </IPAddress >

5.4.4 /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/<ID>/wireless

URI /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/ID/wireless Type Command Function Access wireless network settings. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <Wireless> PUT <Wireless> <ResponseStatus> Notes If the <securityMode> field is “WEP”, the <WEP> block must be provided. If the <securityMode> field is “WPA” or “WPA2-personal”, the <WPA> block must be provided. If the “WPA” or “WPA2-enterprise” security mode is used, the <WPA> block must be used and settings related to 802. 1x must be set using the /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/ID/ieee802.1x resource. <channel> corresponds to an 802.11g wireless channel number or “auto” for autoconfiguration. <wmmEnabled> enables 802.11e, QoS for IEEE 802.11 networks (Wi-Fi Multimedia) <defaultTransmitKeyIndex> indicates which encryption key is used for WEP security. <encryptionKey> is the WEP encryption key in hexadecimal format. <sharedKey> is the pre-shared key used in WPA <OptimalWiFiAPSelection> is used to enable/disable optimal Wifi selection mode <testConnectivity>, for PUT method and if enabled, Camera should verify Wifi connectivity with the configured AP (Camera must validate connectivity and not just association, e.g., Camera can obtain IP address via DHCP). Upon receiving a valid <testConnectivity> Command, Camera should respond with <ResponseStatus>, and then send a yyy notification to the Gateway after connectivity test. For Camera that only supports one physical network interface, Camera may disconnect after responding with <ResponseStatus>, run Wifi connectivity test, reconnect to the original interface and send notification to Gateway.

Wireless XML Block

<Wireless version=“1.0”> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> <wirelessNetworkMode><!-- opt, xs:string, “infrastructure,adhoc” --> </wirelessNetworkMode> <channel> <!-- opt, xs:string, “1-14,auto” --> </channel> <ssid> <!-- opt, xs:string --> </ssid> <wmmEnabled> <!-- opt, xs:boolean --> </wmmEnabled> <WirelessSecurity> <!-- opt -->  <securityMode> <!-- opt, xs:string, “disable,WEP,WPA-personal,WPA2-  personal,WPA-RADIUS,WPA-enterprise,WPA2-enterprise” --></securityMode>  <WEP> <!-- dep, depends on <securityMode> --> <authenticationType> <!-- req, xs:string, “open,sharedkey,auto” -- ></authenticationType> <defaultTransmitKeyIndex> <!-- req, xs:integer --> </defaultTransmitKeyIndex> <wepKeyLength> <!-- opt, xs:integer “64,128” --> </wepKeyLength> <EncryptionKeyList>  <encryptionKey> <!-- req, xs:hexBinary, WEP encryption key in  hexadecimal format --></encryptionKey> </EncryptionKeyList>  </WEP>  <WPA> <!-- dep, depends on <securityMode> --> <algorithmType> <!-- req, xs:string, “TKIP,AES,TKIP/AES”--> </algorithmType> <sharedKey> <!-- req, xs:string, pre-shared key used in WPA --> </sharedKey>  </WPA> </WirelessSecurity> < statusRefreshInterval> <!-- req, xs:integer, max internval between wireless status refresh in sec --> </statusRefreshInterval > <OptimalWiFiAPSelection> <!-- opt --> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> <checkInterval> <!-- req, xs:integer in seconds --> </checkInterval > <switchThreshold> <!-- req, xs:percentage --> </switchThreshold > <minSwitchTime> <!-- req, xs: integer in seconds --> </minSwitchTime> </OptimalWiFiAPSelection> <testConnectivity> <!-- opt, valid only with PUT method -->  <enable><!-- req, xs:boolean --></enable>  <timeout> <!--dep, valid value is 10~1200, unit is second -->  </timeout>  <ResultNotifyURL> <!-- dep, notification URL for sending WiFi connectivity test result, see <WifiConnectivityTestResult> Notificaiton -->  </ResultNotifyURL>  </testConnectivity> </Wireless >

5.4.4.1 Notification: WifiConnectivityTestResult

URI http or Type Notification https://<ipAddess>:<portNo>/<notificationURL> or poll:// <notificationURL> Function This function is used by the Camera to send Wifi connectivity test result to the Gateway. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result POST WifiConnectivityTestResult Notes <notificationURL> is derived from <Wireless> XML Block's <testConnectivity> parameters dateTime is in ISO 8601 Date-Time format.

WifiConnectivityTestResult XML Block

<WifiConnectivityTestResult version=“1.0”> <id> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </id> <associated><!-- req, xs:boolean --> </ associated > <errorReason> <!-- dep, xs:string (req if association is false) --> </ errorReason> <dateTime> <!-- opt, xs:datetime, when test was performed --> </dateTime> <!-- the following paramerters are required if associated is true → <channelNo> <!-- req, xs:string, “1-14” current channel No--> </channelNo> <ssid> <!-- req, xs:string --> </ssid> <bssid> <!-- req, xs:string --> </bssid> <rssidB><!-- req, xs:integer, received signal strength indicator in dB --> </rssidB > </ WifiConnectivityTestResult >

5.4.5 /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/<ID>/wireless/status

URI /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/ID/wireless/status Type Command Function Access interface status. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET forceRefresh (optional) <WirelessNetworkStatus> Notes This resource is read-only. If ‘forceRefresh’ query parameter is ‘true’, device should collect a new set of <WirelessNetworkStatus> data before returning result. If ‘forceRefresh’ parameter is false or missing, device should return <WirelessNetworkStatus> without collecting new data. Data underlying <WirelessNetworkStatus> should be periodically refreshed by the device at maximum interval of <statusRefreshInterval> seconds defined in the <Wireless> XML block.

WirelessNetworkStatus XML Block

<WirelessNetworkStatus version=“1.0”> <enabled> <!-- ro,req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> <channelNo> <!-- ro,req, xs:string, “1-14” current channel No--> </channelNo> <ssid> <!-- ro,req, xs:string --> </ssid> <bssid> <!-- ro,req, xs:string --> </bssid> <rssidB><!-- ro,req, xs:integer, received signal strength indicator in dB --> </rssidB > <signalStrength><!-- ro,req, xs:integer, 0-100 %- -></signalStrength> <noiseIndB> ><!-- ro,req, xs:integer, noise level in dB --> </noiseIndB > <numOfAPs> <!-- ro,req, xs:string --> </numOfAPs> <AvailableAPList> <!-- ro,opt --> <AvailableAccessPoint> <!-- ro,opt --> <ssid> <!-- ro,req, xs:string --> </ssid> <bssid> <!-- ro,req, xs:string --> </bssid> <rssidB><!-- ro,req, xs:integer, received signal strength indicator in dB --> </ rssidB > <securityMode> <!-- ro,req, xs:string, “disable,WEP,WPA-  personal,WPA2-personal,WPA- RADIUS,WPA-enterprise,WPA2-  enterprise” --></securityMode> </AvailableAccessPoint > </AvailableAPList> </WirelessNetworkStatus >

5.4.6 /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/<ID>/ieee802.1x

URI /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/ID/ieee802.1x Type Command Function Access IEEE 802.1x settings. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <IEEE802_1x> PUT <IEEE802_1x> <ResponseStatus> Notes If the <authenticatonProtocolType> tag corresponds to “EAP-TTLS”, then the <innerTTLSAuthenticationMethod> tag must be provided. If the <authenticationProtocolType> corresponds to “EAP-PEAP” or “EAP-FAST”, then the <innerEAPProtocolType> tag must be provided. The <anonymousID> tag is optional. If the <authenticationProtocolType> corresponds to “EAP-FAST”, then the <autoPACProvisioningEnabled> tag must be provided. <anonymousID> is the optional anonymous ID to be used in place of the <userName>.

IEEE802_1x XML Block

<IEEE802_1x version=“1.0”> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> <authenticationProtocolType> <!-- req, xs:string, “EAP-TLS,EAP-TTLS,EAP-PEAP,EAP-LEAP,EAP-FAST” --> </authenticationProtocolType> <innerTTLSAuthenticationMethod> <!-- dep, xs:string, “MS-CHAP,MS-CHAPv2,PAP,EAP-MD5” --> </innerTTLSAuthenticationMethod> <innerEAPProtocolType><!-- dep, xs:string, “EAP-POTP,MS-CHAPv2” --> </innerEAPProtocolType> <validateServerEnabled> <!-- dep, xs:boolean --> </validateServerEnabled> <userName> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </userName> <password> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </password> <anonymousID> <!-- opt, xs:string --> </anonymousID> <autoPACProvisioningEnabled> <!-- dep, xs:boolean --> </autoPACProvisioningEnabled> </IEEE802_1x >

5.4.7 /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/<ID>/discovery

URI /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/ID/discovery Type Command Function Device discovery settings. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <Discovery> PUT <Discovery> <ResponseStatus> Notes Use of IPv4 or IPv6 addresses depends on the value of the <ipVersion> field in /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/ID/ipAddress. <portNo> is the port number for the multicast discovery address. <ttl> is the time to live for multicast discovery packets.

Discovery XML Block

<Discovery version=“1.0”> <UPnP> <!-- req --> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> </UPnP> <Zeroconf> <!-- opt --> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> </Zeroconf> <MulticastDiscovery> <!-- opt --> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> <ipAddress> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipAddress> <ipv6Address> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipv6Address> <portNo> <!-- req, xs:integer --> </portNo> <ttl> <!-- req, xs:integer --> </ttl> </MulticastDiscovery> </ Discovery>

5.5 /OpenHome/System/Audio Data Type Details

5.5.1 /OpenHome/System/Audio/channels

URI /OpenHome/System/Audio/channels Type Command Function Access audio channels. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <AudioChannelList> Notes Since inputs are resources that are defined by the hardware configuration of the device, audio channels cannot be created or deleted. ID numbering or values should be considered arbitrary and device-dependent.

AudioChannelList XML Block

<AudioChannelList version=“1.0”> <AudioChannel/> <!-- opt --> </AudioChannelList >

5.5.2 /OpenHome/System/Audio/channels/<ID>

URI /OpenHome/System/Audio/channels/ID Type Command Function Access audio channels. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <AudioChannel> PUT <AudioChannel> <ResponseStatus> Notes <audioMode> is the duplex mode for audio transmission between the client and media device. <microphoneSource> indicates whether the device microphone is internal or external. <microphoneVolume> Volume control percentage for device microphone. 0 is mute. <speakerVolume> Volume control percentage for device speaker. 0 is mute.

AudioChannel XML Block

<AudioChannel version=“1.0”> <id> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </id> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> <audioMode><!-- req, xs:string, “listenonly,talkonly,talkorlisten,talkandlisten” --> </audioMode> <microphoneEnabled> <!-- opt, xs:boolean --> </microphoneEnabled> <microphoneSource> <!-- opt, xs:string, “internal,external” --> </microphoneSource> <microphoneVolume> <!-- opt, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </microphoneVolume> <speakerEnabled> <!-- opt, xs:boolean --> </speakerEnabled> <speakerVolume> <!-- opt, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </speakerVolume> </AudioChannel>

5.6 /OpenHome/System/Video Data Type Details

5.6.1 /OpenHome/System/Video/inputs

URI /OpenHome/System/Video/inputs Type Command Function Access the video inputs on an IP media device. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <VideoInput> Notes An IP media device may contain a set of video inputs. These inputs are hardwired by the device, meaning that the IDs can be discovered but not created or deleted. ID numbering or values should be considered arbitrary and device-dependent.

VideoInput XML Block

<VideoInput version=“1.0”> <VideoInputChannelList/> <!-- opt --> </VideoInput >

5.6.1 /OpenHome/System/Video/inputs/channels

URI /OpenHome/System/Video/inputs/channels Type Command Function Access the video inputs on an IP media device. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <VideoInputChannelList> Notes Since video input channels are resources that are defined by the hardware configuration of the device, they cannot be created or deleted.

VideoInputChannel XML Block

<VideoInputChannelList version=“1.0”> <VideoInputChannel/><!-- opt --> </VideoInputChannelList >

5.6.3 /OpenHome/System/Video/inputs/channels/<ID>

URI /OpenHome/System/Video/inputs/channels/ID Type Command Function Access video input channel properties. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <VideoInputChannel> PUT <VideoInputChannel> <ResponseStatus> Notes <powerLineFrequencyMode> is used to adjust/correct video image based on different power frequencies. <whiteBalanceMode> indicates the white balance operational mode. <whiteBalanceLevel> indicates the white balance percentage value when whiteBalanceMode refers to manual. 0 is ‘cool’, 100 is ‘hot’. <exposureMode> indicates the exposure operational mode. <exposureTarget> the target exposure for manual or auto-exposure. <exposureAutoMin> minimum exposure when <exposureMode> is set to auto. <exposureAutoMax> maximum exposure when <exposureMode> is set to auto. <GainWindow> defines the coordinates of the window used to determine the auto-gain statistics, if smaller than the entire window. <gainLevel> indicates the gain level percentage value when <exposureMode> refers to Manual. 0 is low gain, 100 is high gain. <irisMode> indicates the iris operational mode. Only applicable for auto-iris lens modules. Override will put lens module into manual mode until the scene changes, at which point operation is switched to the auto mode. <focusMode> indicates the focus operational mode. Only applicable for auto-focus lens modules. Override will put lens module into manual mode until the scene changes, at which point operation is switched to the auto mode. In <DayNightFilter>, <beginTime> and <endTime> are only used if <switchScheduleEnabled> is true.

VideoInputChannel XML Block

<VideoInputChannel version=“1.0”> <id> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </id> <inputPort> <!-- opt, xs:string --> </inputPort> <powerLineFrequencyMode> <!-- opt, xs:string “50hz, 60hz” --> </powerLineFrequencyMode> <whiteBalanceMode> <!-- opt, xs:string, “manual,auto,indoor/incandescent,fluorescent/white, fluorescent/yellow,outdoor,black&white”--> </whiteBalanceMode> <whiteBalanceLevel> <!-- dep, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </whiteBalanceLevel> <exposureMode> <!-- opt, xs:string, “manual, auto” --> </exposureMode> <Exposure> <!-- opt --> <exposureTarget> <!-- req, xs:integer, microseconds --> </exposureTarget> <exposureAutoMin> <!-- req, xs:integer, microseconds --> </exposureAutoMin> <exposureAutoMax> <!-- req, xs:integer, microseconds --> </exposureAutoMax> </Exposure> <GainWindow> <!-- opt --> <RegionCoordinatesList> <!-- opt --> <RegionCoordinates> <!-- opt --> <positionX> <!-- req, xs:integer;coordinate --> </positionX> <positionY> <!-- req, xs:integer;coordinate --> </positionY> </RegionCoordinates> </RegionCoordinatesList> </GainWindow> <gainLevel> <!-- dep, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </gainLevel> <brightnessLevel> <!-- opt, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </brightnessLevel> <contrastLevel> <!-- opt, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </contrastLevel> <sharpnessLevel> <!-- opt, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </sharpnessLevel> <saturationLevel> <!-- opt, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </saturationLevel> <hueLevel> <!-- opt, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </hueLevel> <gammaCorrectionEnabled> <!-- opt, xs:boolean --> </gammaCorrectionEnabled> <gammaCorrectionLevel> <!-- opt, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </gammaCorrectionLevel> <WDREnabled> <!-- opt, xs:boolean --> </WDREnabled> <WDRLevel> <!-- opt, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </WDRLevel> <LensList><!-- opt --> <Lens> <!-- opt --> <lensModuleName> <!-- opt, xs:string --> </lensModuleName> <irisMode><!-- opt, xs:string, “manual,auto,override” --> </irisMode> <focusMode> <!-- opt, xs:string, “manual,auto,autobackfocus,override” -- ></focusMode> </Lens> </LensList> <DayNightFilter> <!-- opt --> <dayNightFilterType> <!-- req, xs:string, “day,night,auto” -- ></dayNightFilterType> <switchScheduleEnabled><!-- opt, xs:boolean --> </switchScheduleEnabled> <beginTime> <!-- dep, xs:time --> </beginTime> <endTime> <!-- dep, xs:time --> </endTime> <illuminationSwitchOver> <!-- opt --> <enabled> > <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> <threshold> <!-- req, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </threshold> </illuminationSwitchOver> </DayNightFilter> <shutterspeed> <!-- req, xs:integer --> </shtterspeed> <rotationDegree> <!-- opt, xs:integer, degrees, 0..360 --></rotationDegree> <mirrorEnabled> <!-- opt, xs:boolean --> </mirrorEnabled> </VideoInputChannel >

5.7 /OpenHome/Security Data Type Details

5.7.1 /OpenHome/Security/updateSSLCertificate/

Camera should support both client SSL certificates (used for validating Gateway identity) as well as server SSL certificates (used for Gateway to validate a camera's identity). One or more client SSL certificates are pre-configured in the Camera, but can be updated via the /OpenHome/Security/updateSSLCertificate/client Command. Server SSL certificate is used only if Interface Type 1B—HTTP/HTTPS Command/Notification Channel is activated, and it is usually not pre-configured at the device. Procedures for updating Camera's client SSL certificate is as follows:

1. Gateway invokes /OpenHome/Security/updateSSLCertificate/server Command to start Certificate Signing Request (CSR) process, Command parameters includes the common name (CN) field to be used as part of the CSR request. CN utilizes the “<serial>-<siteid>-<timestamp>” format.

2. Camera generates its own public/private key pair (if it doesn't have one already)

3. Camera invokes /OpenHome/Security/certificateSigningRequest/server Notification to Gateway, submits this CSR to the server for signing. This is an HTTPS POST request using basic Authorization with the device serial number and key as username and password (see Section 4.1.2.2 Camera Originated Notifications).

4. Gateway authenticates the CSR request (verifies username and password), invokes a check command on the gateway (passing the CN) in order to obtain approval to process the CSR, and if approved, then signs and returns the result to the camera

5.7.1.1 /OpenHome/Security/updateSSLCertificate/client

URI /OpenHome/Security/updateSSLCertificate/client Type Command Function This function is used to trigger the device to retrieve an updated client SSL certificate Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result POST <UpdateSSLCertCommand> <ResponseStatus> GET Exisitng client certificates in PEM format Notes For client SSL certificate retrieval, the <clientCert> element is required. Must use either HTTPS or XMPP to request this Command. Caemra returns <ResponseStatus> with reboot-required parameter. Camera should verify certificate validity and ignore certificate if not validate. This Command updates client certificates beyond the pre-configured client certificates on the device. It does NOT replace or remove the pre-configured client certificates.

UpdateSSLCertCommand XML Block

<UpdateSSLCertCommand version=“1.0”> <serverCert> <!-- dep --> <url><!-- req, xs:string, url where to retrieve the updated certificate--> </url> <csr> <!-- req --> <CN> <!-- req, xs:string, common name to be used in Certificate Signing Request--> </CN> </csr> </serverCert> <clientCert> <!-- dep --> <url><!-- req, xs:string, url where to retrieve the updated certificate--> </url> </clientCert> </UpdateSSLCertCommand >

5.7.1.2 /OpenHome/Security/updateSSLCertificate/server

URI /OpenHome/Security/updateSSLCertificate/server Type Command Function This function is used to trigger the device to request a new SSL server certificate for the device (used for HTTPS transaction requests to the device) Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result POST <UpdateSSLCertCommand> <ResponseStatus> GET Exisitng client certificates in PEM format Notes For server SSL certificate retrieval, the <serverCert> element is required. If HTTPS Command/Notification Channel is used to request this Command, HTTP (not HTTPS) will be the underlying transport. Caemra returns <ResponseStatus> with reboot-required parameter. Camera should verify certificate validity and ignore certificate if not validate.

5.7.1.3 Request for updateSSLCertificate

URI https://<hostName>:<portNo>/<updateSSLCertGatewayURL> Type HTTPS or Request xmpp://<hostName>:<portNo>/<updateSSLCertGatewayURL> from Camera to Gateway Function This function is used to request signing of the device's server certificate from Camera to Gateway Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result POST <CertificationRequestInfo> <CertificationRequest> Notes <updateSSLCertGatewayURL>, <hostname>, are derived from the /OpenHome/Security/updateSSLCertificate/server's <ServerCert> element. Examples: https://192.168.2.200:5000/Notification/updateSSLCertRequest/006222000122 or xmpp://192.168.2.200:5000/Notification/updateSSLCertRequest/006222000122 <CertificateSigningRequest> and <CertificationRequest> are defined in RFC 2986 (PKCS #10: Certification Request Syntax Specification).

5.7.2 /OpenHome/Security/AAA/accounts

User and administration accounts on the Camera can be retrieved and configured via the following data types.

5.7.2.1 /OpenHome/Security/AAA/accounts

URI /OpenHome/Security/AAA/Accounts Type Command Function Access the device's user list Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <AccountList> PUT <AccountList> <ResponseStatus> POST <Account> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes For server SSL certificate retrieval, the <serverCert> element is required. It is possible to add, remove and update users entries in the list. Passwords can only be uploaded - they are never revealed during GET operations.

UserList XML Block

<UserList version=“1.0”> <Account/> <!-- opt --> </UserList >

5.7.2.2 /OpenHome/Security/AAA/accounts/<ID>

URI /OpenHome/Security/AAA/accounts/ID Type Command Function Authentication account settings Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <Account> PUT <Account> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes Each <protocolID> tag, if <ProtocolList> is provided, must match a corresponding <id> tag in /OpenHome/Security/adminAccesses. Note: <password> is a write-only field.

Account XML Block

<Account version=“1.0”>  <id> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </id>  <userName> <!-- req, xs:string --> </userName>  <password> <!-- wo, req, xs:string --> </password>  <accessRights> <!-- req, xs:string, “admin”, “user” --> </accessRights> </Account>

5.7.3 Authorization

5.7.3.1 /OpenHome/Security/Authorization/

URI /OpenHome/Security/Authorization Type Command Function This function is used to get authorization credential from Camera to Gateway Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <AuthorizationInfo> PUT <AuthorizationInfo> <ResponseStatus> Notes siteID is defined in Appendix B Step 1 - Retrieve Gateway URL and SiteID. SharedSecreit is defined in in Appendix B Step 2 - Retrieve Credential. <credentialGWURL> is defined in in Appendix B Step 2 - Retrieve Credential. pendignKey is defined in in Appendix B Step 2 - Retrieve Credential.

AuthorizationInfo XML Block

<AuthorizationInfo version=“1.0”>  <siteID> <!-- req, xs:string --> </siteID >  <sharedSecret> <!-- req, xs:string --> </sharedSecret >  <pendingKey> <!-- req, xs:string --> </pendigKey >  <credentialGWURL>  <!-- req, xs:string -->  </credentialGWURL> </Authorization>

5.8 /OpenHome/Streaming Data Type Details

5.8.1 Configuring Audio/Video/Image Channels

5.8.1.1 /OpenHome/Streaming/channels

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/channels Type Command Function This function is used to configure or get streaming channels Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <StreamingChannelList> PUT <StreamingChannelList> <ResponseStatus> POST <StreamingChannel> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes Streaming channels may be hardwired, or it may be possible to create multiple streaming channels per input if the device supports it.

StreamingChannelList XML Block

<StreamingChannelList version=“1.0”> <StreamingChannel/> <!-- opt --> </StreamingChannelList >

5.8.1.2 /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/ID Type Command Function This function is used to configure or get streaming channels Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <StreamingChannel> PUT <StreamingChannel> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes <ControlProtocolList> identifies the control protocols that are valid for this type of streaming. <Unicast> is for direct unicast streaming. <Multicast> is for direct multicast streaming. <videoSourcePortNo> and <audioSourcePortNo> are the source port numbers for the outbound video or audio streams. <videoInputChannelID> refers to /OpenHome/System/Video/inputs/channel/ID. <audioInputChannelID> refers to /OpenHome/System/Audio/channels/ID. It must be configured as an input channel. Use of IPv4 or IPv6 addresses depends on the value of the <ipVersion> field in /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/ID/ipAddress. <Security> determines whether SRTP is used for stream encryption. <audioResolution> is the resolution for the outbound audio stream in bits. <mediaCapture> is only required if the device requires pre-configuration of pre/post capture buffer duration.

StreamingChannel XML Block

<StreamingChannel version=“1.0”> <id> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </id> <channelName> <!-- opt, xs:string --> </channelName> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> <Transport> <!-- req --> <rtspPortNo> <!-- opt, xs:integer --> </rtspPortNo> <maxPacketSize> <!-- opt, xs:integer --> </maxPacketSize> <audioPacketLength> <!-- opt, xs:integer --> </audioPacketLength> <audioInboundPacketLength><!-- opt, xs:integer --> </audioInboundPacketLength> <audioInboundPortNo> <!-- opt, xs:integer --> </audioInboundPortNo> <videoSourcePortNo> <!-- opt, xs:integer --> </videoSourcePortNo> <audioSourcePortNo> <!-- opt, xs:integer --> </audioSourcePortNo> <ControlProtocolList> <!-- req --> <ControlProtocol> <!-- req -->  <streamingTransport><!-- req, xs:string, “HTTP,RTSP” -->  </streamingTransport> </ControlProtocol> </ControlProtocolList> <Unicast> <!-- opt --> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> <interfaceID> <!-- opt, xs:string --> </interfaceID> <rtpTransportType><!-- opt, xs:string, “RTP/UDP,RTP/TCP” --> </rtpTransportType> </Unicast> <Multicast> <!-- opt -->  <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled>  <userTriggerThreshold> <!--opt,xs:integer--></userTriggerThreshold>  <destIPAddress>  <!-- dep, xs:string --> </destIPAddress> <videoDestPortNo><!-- opt, xs:integer --></videoDestPortNo> <audioDestPortNo> <!-- opt, xs:integer --> </audioDestPortNo> <destIPv6Address> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </destIPv6Address> <ttl> <!-- opt, xs:integer --> </ttl> </Multicast> <Security> <!-- opt --> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> </Security> </Transport> <Video> <!-- opt --> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> <videoInputChannelID> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </videoInputChannelID> <videoCodecType><!-- req, xs:string, “MPEG4,MJPEG,3GP,H.264,MPNG” --> </videoCodecType> <videoScanType><!-- opt, xs:string, “progressive,interlaced” --> </videoScanType> <videoResolutionWidth> <!-- req, xs:integer --> </videoResolutionWidth> <videoResolutionHeight> <!-- req, xs:integer --> </videoResolutionHeight> <videoPositionX> <!-- opt, xs:integer --> </videoPositionX> <videoPositionY> <!-- opt, xs:integer --> </videoPositionY> <videoQualityControlType><!-- opt, xs:string, “cbr,vbr” --> </videoQualityControlType> <constantBitRate> <!-- dep, xs:integer, in kbps --> </constantBitRate> <fixedQuality> <!-- opt, xs:integer, percentage, 0..100 --> </fixedQuality> <vbrUpperCap> <!-- dep, xs:integer, in kbps --> </vbrUpperCap> <vbrLowerCap> <!-- dep, xs:integer, in kbps --> </vbrLowerCap> <maxFrameRate> <!-- req, xs:integer, maximum frame rate x100 --> </maxFrameRate> <keyFrameInterval> <!-- opt, xs:integer, milliseconds --> </keyFrameInterval> <govLength> <!-- opt, xs:integer, number of frames --> </govLength> <rotationDegree> <!-- opt, xs:integer, degrees, 0..360 --></rotationDegree> <mirrorEnabled> <!-- opt, xs:boolean --> </mirrorEnabled> <snapShotImageType><!-- opt, xs:string, “JPEG,GIF,PNG” --> </snapShotImageType> </Video> <Audio> <!-- opt --> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> <audioInputChannelID> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </audioInputChannelID> <audioCompressionType> <!-- req, xs:string, “G.711alaw,G.711ulaw,G.726,G.729,G.729a,G.729b,PCM,MP3,AC3,AAC,ADPCM”--> </audioCompressionType> <audioInboundCompressionType> <!-- opt, xs:string, “G.711alaw,G.711ulaw,G.726,G.729,G.729a,G.729b,PCM,MP3,AC3,AAC,ADPCM”--> </audioInboundCompressionType> <audioBitRate> <!-- opt, xs:integer, in kbps --> </audioBitRate> <audioSamplingRate> <!-- opt, xs:float, in kHz --> </audioSamplingRate> <audioResolution> <!-- opt, xs:integer, in bits -->    </audioResolution> </Audio> <MediaCapture> <!-- opt --> <preCaptureLength> <!-- req, xs:integer, milliseconds --> </preCaptureLength > <postCaptureLength> <!-- req, xs:integer, milliseconds --> </postCaptureLength > </MediaCapture> </StreamingChannel >

5.8.1.3 /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/capabilities

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/capabilities Type Command Function This function is used to get capability of a specific channel and streaming protocol Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <StreamingCapabilities> Notes

StreamingCapabilities XML Block

<StreamingCapabilities version=“1.0”>  <id opt=“<!--req xs:integer, list of channel ID-->“>  <!--req xs:integer, default  channel ID--> </id>  <channelName min=“0” max=“64”> <!-- opt xs:string, default descriptive name -->  </channelName >  <enabled opt=“true,false”> <!-- req xs:string -->  </enabled> <ControlProtocolList> <!-- req --> <ControlProtocol> <!-- req -->  <streamingTransport opt=“RTSP/RTP,HTTP”>  <!-- req xs:string--> </streamingTransport> </ControlProtocol> </ControlProtocolList> <Video> <!-- req --> <enabled opt=“true,false”> <!-- req xs:string --> </enabled> <videoInputChannelID opt=“=“<!--req xs:integer, list of video input channel ID-->“> <!-- req xs:integer --> </videoInputChannelID> <videoCodecType opt=“MJPEG,MPEG4,H264,3GPP”> <!-- req xs:string --> </videoCodecType> <videoResolutionWidth min=“0” max=“<!-- req xs:integer, max width-->“> req xs:integer </videoResolutionWidth>  <videoResolutionHeight min=“0” max=“<!-- req xs:integer, max height-->“> req xs:integer </videoResolutionHeight> <videoQualityControlType opt=“CBR,VBR”> <!-- req xs:string --> </videoQualityControlType> <constantBitRate min=“<!-- req xs:integer, min Kbps-->“ max=“<!-- req xs:integer, max Kbps-->“> <!-- req xs:integer, Kbps --> </constantBitRate> <maxFrameRate min=“<!-- req xs:integer, min fps-->“ max=“<!-- req xs:integer, max fps-->“ dynamic=“<true \ false>“ > <!-- req xs:integer, fps --> </maxFrameRate> <snapShotImageType opt=“JPEG” def=“JPEG”> <!-- req xs:string --> </snapShotImageType> </Video> <Audio> <!-- req -->  <enabled opt=“true,false” def=“false”> <!-- req xs:string --> </enabled>  <audioInputChannelID opt=“<!--req xs:integer, list of audio input ID-->“><!-- req xs:integer --> </audioInputChannelID> <audioCompressionType opt=“G.726,G.711ulaw,711alaw,AMR,AAC” def=“711ulaw”> req xs:string </audioCompressionType> <audioBitRate opt=“<!-- req xs:integer, list of rates -->“ def=“32” dynamic=“true”>24</audioBitRate> </Audio>  <MediaCapture> <!-- opt --> <preCaptureLength opt=“<!-- req xs:integer -->“> <!-- req, xs:integer, milliseconds --> </preCaptureLength > <postCaptureLength opt=“<!-- req xs:integer -->“> <!-- req, xs:integer, milliseconds --> </postCaptureLength > </MediaCapture> </ StreamingCapabilities>

5.8.1.4 Encoder Channel Query Capability and Set Configuration Example

The following example illustrates a Gateway querying Camera's encoder channel 1's capabilities and base on capability received, set channel 1 with desired configurations. Note, Authorization flow examples not shown.

Gateway−>Camera (get capability for encoder channel 1) GET /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/1/capabilities HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 Pragma: no-cache Cache-Control: no-cache Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT Camera−>Gateway (response) HTTP/1.1 200 OK Content-Type: application/xml; charset=“UTF-8” Connection: Keep-Alive Content-Length: <size of the xml body below in bytes> <StreamingCapabilities version=“1.0”> <id opt=“1,2”>1</id> <channelName min=“0” max=“64”></channelName> <ControlProtocolList> <ControlProtocol> <streamingTransport opt=“RTSP/RTP”>RTSP/RTP</streamingTransport> </ControlProtocol> </controlProtocolList> <Video> <enabled opt=“true,false”>true</enabled> <VideoInputChannelID opt=“0,1”>1</VideoInputChannelID> <videoCodecType opt=“MPEG4,H264,3GPP”>MPEG4</videoCodecType> <videoResolutionWidth min=“0” max=“640”>0</videoResolutionWidth> <videoResolutionHeight min=“0” max=“480”>0</videoResolutionHeight> <videoQualityControlType opt=“CBR,VBR”>CBR</videoQualityControlType> <constantBitRate min=“0” max=“2000” dynamic=“true”>500</constantBitRate> <maxFrameRate min=“0” max=”30” dynamic=”true”>15</maxFrameRate> <snapShotImageTpe opt=”JPEG”>JPEG</snapShotImageTpe> </Video> <Audio> <enabled opt=“true,false”>true</enabled> <audioInputChannelID opt=“1”>1</audioInputChannelID> <aduioCompressionType opt=G.726,G.711ulaw,G.711alaw,AMR,AAC”>G.726 </aduioCompressionType> <audioBitRate opt=“32”>32</audioBitRate> </Audio> </StreamingCapabilities> Gateway−>Camera (set encoder channel 1's configuration) PUT /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/1 HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 Pragma: no-cache Cache-Control: no-cache Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT Content-Type: application/xml; charset=“UTF-8” Content-Length: <size of the xml body below in bytes> <StreamingChannel version=“1.0”> <id>1</id> <channelName>rtsp channel 1</channelName> <enabled>true</enabled> <Transport> <ControlProtocol> <streamingTransport>RTSP/RTP</streamingTransport> </Transport> <Video> <enabled>true</enabled> <VideoInputChannelID>0</VideoInputChannelID> <videoCodecType>H264</videoCodecType> <videoResolutionWidth>640</videoResolutionWidth> <videoResolutionHeight>480</videoResolutionHeight> <videoQualityControlType>CBR</videoQualityControlType> <constantBitRate>750</constantBitRate> <fixedQuality>70</fixedQuality> <maxFrameRate>30</maxFrameRate> <snapShotImageTpe>JPEG</snapShotImageTpe> </Video> <Audio> <enabled>false</enabled> </Audio> </StreamingChannel> Camera−>Gateway (response) HTTP/1.1 200 OK Content-Type: application/xml; charset=“UTF-8” Connection: Keep-Alive Content-Length: <size of the xml body below in bytes> <ResponseStatus version=“1.0”> <statusCode>1</statusCode> <statusString>OK</statusString> </ResponseStatus>

5.8.2 Accessing Live Video and Channel Status

5.8.2.1 /OpenHome/Streaming/status

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/status Type Command Function This function is used to get Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <StreamingStatus> Notes This command accesses the status of all device-streaming sessions.

StreamingStatus XML Block

<StreamingStatus version=“1.0”>  <totalStreamingSessions> <!-- req, xs:integer -->  </totalStreamingSessions>  <StreamingSessionStatusList/> <!-- dep, only if there are sessions --> </StreamingStatus >

5.8.2.2 /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/status

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/status Type Command Function Get the list of streaming sessions associated with a particular channel. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <StreamingSessionStatusList> Notes Use of IPv4 or IPv6 addresses depends on the value of the <ipVersion> field in /OpenHome/System/Network/interfaces/ID/ipAddress. dateTime is in ISO 8601 Date/Time string format.

StreamingSessionStatus XML Block

<StreamingSessionStatusList version=“1.0”> <StreamingSessionStatus version=“1.0”>  <clientAddress> <!-- req --> <ipAddress> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipAddress> <ipv6Address> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </ipv6Address>  </clientAddress>  <clientUserName>  <!-- opt, xs:string --> </clientUserName>  <startDateTime> <!-- opt, xs:datetime --> </startDateTime>  <elapsedTime> <!-- req, xs:integer, seconds --> </elapsedTime>  <bandwidth> <!-- opt, xs:integer, in kbps --> </bandwidth>  <txPackets>  <!-- opt, xs:integer, # of packets transmitted--> </ txPackets >  <rxPackets>  <!-- opt, xs:integer, # of packets received--> </ rxPackets > </StreamingSessionStatus > </StreamingSessionStatusList>

5.8.2.3 /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/rtsp

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/ID/rtsp Type Command Function This function is used to request streaming of video from Camera via RTSP Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result RTSP videoCodecType Stream over RTSP videoResolutionWidth videoResolutionHeight videoQualityControlType constantBitRate fixedQuality vbrUpperCap vbrLowerCap maxFrameRate keyFrameInterval Notes Each channel <ID> is pre-configured with encoding capabilities specific that channel; capabilities include codec type, bitrate, resolution, etc.A channel must be configured to enable RTSP for this Command to succeed. See /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>. All query parameters are optional and can be used to override existing profile configuration for a specific channel <ID>; however, if a device does NOT support dynamic reconfiguration of any of the requested parameters, the device may return HTTP error instead of a valid stream. Device should support RTSP over UDP, TCP, HTTP, and HTTPS transports.

5.8.2.4 /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/video/upload

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/ID/video/upload Type Command Function This function is used to trigger a video clip capture and upload from Camera to Gateway Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result POST <MediaUpload> <Response Status> Notes Camera uploads a video clip via procedures describe in Section 4.3.2. If upload failed, Camera should send the MediaUploadFailure Notification. snapShotImageType should not be set for video upload Some devices may not support dynamic request for <preCaptureLength> and <postCapatureLength>; for these devices, use <MediaCapture> configuration in /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID> instead.

MediaUpload XML Block

<MediaUpload version=“1.0”> <id> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </id> <snapShotImageType> <!-- opt, xs:string, “JPEG” --> </snapShotImageType> <videoClipFormatType> <!-- opt, xs:string, “ASF,MP4,3GP,264” -- ></videoClipFormatType> <preCaptureLength> <!-- opt, xs:integer, milliseconds --> </preCaptureLength> <postCaptureLength> <!-- opt, xs:integer, milliseconds --> </postCaptureLength> <videoResolutionWidth> <!-- opt, xs:integer --> </videoResolutionWidth> <videoResolutionHeight> <!-- opt, xs:integer --> </videoResolutionHeight> <gateway _url> <!-- dep, xs:string --> </gateway _url> <failure_url> <!-- dep, xs:string, url to post if upload fails --> </failure_url> </MediaUpload >

5.8.2.5 /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/requestKeyFrame

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/ID/requestKeyFrame Type Command Function Request that the device issue a key frame on a particular profile. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result PUT Stream over RTSP Notes The key frame that is issued should include everything necessary to initialize a video decoder, i.e. parameter sets for H.264 or VOS for MPEG-4.

5.8.2.6 /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/http

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/ID/http Type Command Function This function is used to request streaming of MJPEG video from Camera via HTTP Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET videoCodecType Stream over HTTP videoResolution Width videoResolutionHeight videoQualityControlType constantBitRate fixedQuality vbrUpperCap vbrLowerCap maxFrameRate keyFrameInterval Notes This URI is intended for streaming MJPEG video. For RTSP and HLS video streaming, please refer to /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/rtsp & /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/hls/playlist. Each channel <ID> is pre-configured with encoding capabilities specific that channel; capabilities include codec type, bitrate, resolution, etc. A channel must be configured to enable RTSP for this Command to succeed. See /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>. All query parameters are optional and can be used to override existing profile configuration for a specific channel <ID>; however, if a device does NOT support dynamic change of any of the requested parameters, the device may return HTTP error instead of a valid stream.

5.8.2.7 /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/picture

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/ID/pictures Type Command Function This function is used to request a picture snapshot Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET videoResolutionWidth Picture over HTTPS (optional) videoResolutionHeight (optional) fixedQuality (optional) Notes videoResolutionWidth and videoResolutionHeight are capture image width and height respectively. fixedQuality is the image compression quality, ranges from 1 to 100, with 100 as the highest quality. To determine the format of the picture returned, either the parameters in <Video> or the query string values are used, or, if the Accept: header field is present in the request and the server supports it, the picture is returned in that format.

5.8.2.8 /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/picture/upload

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/ID/picture/upload Type Command Function This function is used to trigger a picture capture and upload from Camera to Gateway Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result POST <MediaUpload> <ResponseStatus> Notes Camera uploads image via procedures describe in Section 4.3.2. If upload failed, Camera should send the MediaUploadFailure Notification. The videoClipFormatType element in <MediaUpload> should not be used for picture upload.

5.8.2.9 /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/hls/playlist

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/ID/ Type Command hls/playlist Function Retrieve HTTP Live Streaming Playlist file Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET HTTP Live Streaming Playlist file Notes This function can be used to retrieve HTTP Live Streaming (HLS) Playlist file in accordance with HLS draft-pantos-http-live-streaming-07. The returned playlist file shall conform to the following requirements: Playlist shall be refreshed periodically at a frequency for supporting real-time streaming Each media segment shall be no longer than 10 sec in duration It is recommended (but not required) that each media segment's URI (in the Playlist) follows the /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/hls/<MediaSegmentID> naming convention For Camera that supports multiple streaming channels from the same input source, the Playlist shall list all media segments from the same source. For example, if input source 1 is used by streaming channels 1 and 2 (where channel 1 encodes at VGA 1 Mbps and channel 2 encodes at QVGA 500 Kbps), both streaming channel 1 and 2's media segments should be presented to the player via the Playlist. The use of “EXT-X-KEY” for media encryption is optional. However, off-premise access must be protected via SSL using the HLS Media Tunnel procedures described in previous section. For on-premise viewing, HTTP Basic Authorization is utilized to authenticate access.

5.8.2.10 /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/hls/<MediaSegment>

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/ID/hls/playlist/MediaSegment Type Command Function Retrieve HTTP Live Streaming media segment Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET HTTP Live Streaming media segment Notes This is the recommended (but not mandatory) HTTP Live Streaming media segment URI format. The actual URI is specified in the HLS Playlist file (see /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/hls/playlist). HTTP Basic Authentication is used to authenticate access. For on-premise viewing, HTTP or HTTPS can be used. For off-premise viewing, media must be protected via SSL using the HLS Media Tunnel procedures.

5.8.2.11 Notification: MediaUploadFailure

The UploadFailure Notification is Sent When a Media Upload Command Fails.

URI http or https://<ipAddess>:<portNo>/<failure_url> Type Notification or xmpp://<ipAddess>:<portNo>/<failure_url> or poll:// <failure_url> Function This function is used by the Camera to send event alerts to the Gateway. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result POST MediaUploadFailure Notes <failure_url> is derived from <MediaUpload> XML Block. dateTime is in ISO 8601 Date-Time format.

MediaUploadFailure XML Block

<MediaUploadFailure version=“1.0”> <id> <!-- req, xs:string;id, ID from MediaUpload request --> </id> <dateTime> <!-- req, xs:datetime, when Command was first received --> </dateTime> <uploadType><!-- req, xs:string, “PICTURE,VIDEOCLIP”--> </uploadType> <eventDescription> <!-- req, xs:string --> </eventDescription> </MediaUploadFailure >

5.8.2.12 Media Streaming Examples

MJPEG Streaming

The following example illustrates how to start a MJPEG video stream from channel 1.

  Gateway−>Camera (start streaming on channel 1) GET /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/1/http HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 ... Camera−>Gateway HTTP/1.1 401 Unauthorized Host: 192.168.2.52 Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:40 GMT WWW-Authenticate: Digest <digest challenge> Gateway−>Camera (start streaming on channel 1) GET /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/1/http HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 Authorization: Digest <challenge response> Pragma: no-cache Cache-Control: no-cache Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT Camera−>Gateway HTTP/1.1 200 OK Content-Type: multipart/x-mixed-replace;boundary=MyRandomStr --MyRandomStr Content-Type: image/jpeg Content-Length: 22444 <jpeg binary data>

Picture Snapshot

The following example illustrates how to capture a JPEG snapshot from channel 1 using a different image resolution than the pre-configured channel image size.

Gateway−>Camera (capture picture) GET /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/1/picture?videoResolutionWidth=320&videoResolution Height=240 HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 ... Camera−>Gateway HTTP/1.1 401 Unauthorized Host: 192.168.2.52 Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:40 GMT WWW-Authenticate: Digest <digest challenge> Gateway−>Camera (capture picture) GET /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/1/picture?videoResolutionWidth=320&videoResolution Height=240 HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 Authorization: Digest <challenge response> Pragma: no-cache Cache-Control: no-cache Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT Camera−>Gateway HTTP/1.1 200 OK Content-Type: image/jpeg Content-Length: 5002 <jpeg binary data>

Trigger a Video Clip Upload

The following example illustrates how to trigger a video clip upload.

Gateway−>Camera (trigger video capture and upload) POST /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/1/video/upload HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 ... Camera−>Gateway (response) HTTP/1.1 401 Unauthorized Host: 192.168.2.52 Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:40 GMT WWW-Authenticate: Digest <digest challenge> Gateway−>Camera (trigger video capture and upload) POST /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/1/video/upload HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 Pragma: no-cache Authorization: Digest <challenge response> Cache-Control: no-cache Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT Content-Type: application/xml; charset=“UTF-8” Content-Length: <size of the xml body below in bytes>  <MediaUpload version=”1.0”>  <id>998d2002</id>  <videoClipFormatType>MP4</videoClipFormatType>  <preCaptureLength>10000</preCaptureLength>  <postCaptureLength>20000</postCaptureLength>  <target_url>  https://gw.icontrol.com/vidupload/43/f/889229dcd864691ffcd4bff342153a00/  </target_url>  <failure_url>  https:// gw.icontrol.com/vidulfailed/43/f/889229dcd864691ffcd4bff342153a00/  </failure_url> </MediaUpload> Camera−>Gateway (response) HTTP/1.1 200 OK Content-Type: application/xml; charset=“UTF-8” Connection: Keep-Alive Content-Length: <size of the xml body below in bytes>  <Response Status version=”1.0”>  <statusCode>1</statusCode>  <statusString>OK</statusString> </ResponseStatus>

Camera Starts Media Upload

Camera−>Gateway (upload video clip) POST /vidupload/43/f/889229dcd864691ffcd4bff342153a00/ HTTP/1.1 Host: gw.icontrol.com ... Gateway −>Camera (response) HTTP/1.1 401 Unauthorized Host: gw.icontrol.com Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:60 GMT WWW-Authenticate: Digest <digest challenge> Camera−>Gateway (upload video clip) POST /vidupload/43/f/889229dcd864691ffcd4bff342153a00/ HTTP/1.1 Host: gw.icontrol.com Content-Type: video/mp4 Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT X-Capture-Time: 1308677301225 Authorization: Digest <challenge response> Content-Length: 144555 <mp4 binary content> Gateway −>Camera (response) HTTP/1.1 200 OK

5.8.1 Media Tunnel Creation and Teardown

5.8.3.1 /OpenHome/Streaming/MediaTunnel

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/MediaTunnel Type Command Function This function is used to get a list of active media tunnels Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <MediaTunnelList> Notes

MediaTunnel XML Block

<MediaTunnelList version=“1.0”> <MediaTunnel/> <!-- opt --> </MediaTunnelList >

5.8.3.2 /OpenHome/Streaming/MediaTunnel/<ID>/status

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/MediaTunnel/ID/ Type Command status Function This function is used to get status of a specific media tunnel Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <MediaTunnel> Notes state varialbes are defined in Sections 4.2.1.1 and 4.2.2.1

MediaTunnel XML Block

<MediaTunnel version=“1.0”> <sessionID> <!-- req, xsistring --> </sessionID> <transportSecurity> <!-- req, xs:string, “TLS,NONE” --> </transportSecurity > <startTime> <!-- opt, xs:datetime --> </startTime> <elapsedTime>  <!-- req, xs:integer, seconds --> </elapsedTime> <state> <!-- opt, xs:string, “IDLE,START,SOCKET_WAITING,SOCKET_CONNECTED,TUNNEL_REA DY, RTSP_INIT,RTSP_READY,RTSP_PLAYING,MJPEG_STREAMING” --> </state> </MediaTunnel >

5.8.3.3 /OpenHome/Streaming/MediaTunnel/create

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/MediaTunnel/ Type Command create Function This function is used to create a media tunnel from Camera to Gateway Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result POST <CreateMediaTunnel> <ResponseStatus> Notes transportSecurity must be set to TLS <sessionUD> is returned as the media tunnel <ID> within <ResponseStatus>

CreateMediaTunnel XML Block

<CreateMediaTunnel version=“1.0”> <sessionID> <!-- req, xs:string --> </sessionID > <gatewayURL> <!-- req, xs:string --> </gatewayURL> <failureURL> <!-- req, xs:string, url to post if create fails --> </failureURL> </CreateMediaTunnel >

5.8.3.4 /OpenHome/Streaming/MediaTunnel/<ID>/destroy

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/MediaTunnel/ Type Command <ID>/destroy Function This function is used to create a media tunnel from Camera to Gateway Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result POST <ResponseStatus> Notes

5.8.3.5 Notification: CreateMediaTunnelFailure

The CreateMediaTunnelFailure Notification is sent when a media tunnel creation Command fails.

URI http or https://<ipAddess>:<portNo>/ Type Notification <failure_url> or xmpp://<ipAddess>:<portNo>/ <failure_url> or poll:// <failure_url> Function This function is used by the Camera to send event alerts to the Gateway. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result POST CreateMediaTunnelFailure Notes <failure_url> is derived from <MediaUpload> XML Block. dateTime is in ISO 8601 Date-Time format.

CreateMediaTunnelFailure XML Block

<CreateMediaTunnelFailure version=“1.0”> <id> <!-- req, xs:string;id, ID from MediaUpload request --> </id> <dateTime> <!-- req, xs:datetime, when Command was first received --> </dateTime> <eventDescription> <!-- req, xs:string --> </eventDescription> </CreateMediaTunnelFailure >

5.9 /OpenHome/PTZ Data Type Details

5.9.1 /OpenHome/PTZ/channels

URI /OpenHome/PTZ/channels Type Command Function Access the list of PTZ channels Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <PTZChannelList> PUT <PTZChannelList> <ResponseStatus> POST <PTZChannel> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes PTZ channels may be hardwired, or it may be possible to create channels if the device supports it. To determine whether it is possible to dynamically PTZ channels, check the defined HTTP methods in /OpenHome/PTZ/channels/description.

PTZChannelList XML Block

<PTZChannelList version=“1.0”> <PTZChannel/> <!-- opt --> </PTZChannelList >

5.9.2 /OpenHome/PTZ/channels/<ID>

URI /OpenHome/PTZ/channels/ID Type Command Function Access or control a PTZ channel Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <PTZChannel> PUT <PTZChannel> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes <videoInputID> links the PTZ channel to a video channel. <panMaxSpeed> defines or limits the maximum pan speed. <tiltMaxSpeed> defines or limits the maximum tilt speed. <autoPatrolSpeed> defines or limits the maximum patrol speed. <controlProtocol> indicates the control protocol to be used for PTZ. Supported protocols are device-dependent. <defaultPreset> identifies the default preset ID to be used with some interfaces.

PTZChannel XML Block

<PTZChannel version=“1.0”> <id> <!-- req, xs:string;id--> </id> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> <videoInputID> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </videoInputID> <panMaxSpeed> <!-- opt, xs: integer, degrees/sec --> </panMaxSpeed> <tiltMaxSpeed> <!-- opt, xs:integer, degrees/sec --> </tiltMaxSpeed> <autoPatrolSpeed> <!-- opt, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </autoPatrolSpeed> <controlProtocol> <!-- opt, xs:string, “pelco-d,...” --> </controlProtocol> <defaultPresetID> <!-- opt, xs:string;id --> </defaultPresetID> </PTZChannel >

5.9.3 /OpenHome/PTZ/channels/<ID>/homePosition

URI /OpenHome/PTZ/channels/ID Type Command Function Set the home position of the PTZ camera to the current position Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <PTZChannel> PUT <PTZChannel> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes This function is used to set the current position as the absolute home position for a PTZ enabled device. After calling this API, the current position will act as the reference point for all absolute PTZ commands sent to the device.

5.9.4 /OpenHome/PTZ/channels/<ID>/relative

URI /OpenHome/PTZ/channels/ID/relative Type Command Function Pans, tilts, and/or zooms the device relative to the current position. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result PUT positionX <PTZData> <ResponseStatus> positionY relativeZoom Notes The device shall not respond with a <ResponseStatus> until the PTZ command has been issued. The total round-trip time for this API should be less than 70 ms. Either the inbound data or query string values are used. The <positionX> and <positionY> tags must be provided in relation to the currently set video resolution. The device will center on the provided coordinates. The <relativeZoom> tag roughly indicates what percentage to zoom in respect to the current image. The auto patrol feature is stopped if it is running.

Relative PTZ Data XML Block

<PTZData version=“1.0”> <Relative>  <positionX> <!-- opt, xs:integer --> </positionX>  <positionY> <!-- opt, xs:integer --> </positionY>  <relativeZoom> <!-- opt, xs:integer, −100..100 -->  </relativeZoom> </Relative> </PTZData >

5.9.5 /OpenHome/PTZ/channels/<ID>/absolute

URI /OpenHome/PTZ/channels/ID/absolute Type Command Function Pans, tilts, and/or zooms the device relative to the absolute home position. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result PUT elevation <PTZData> <ResponseStatus> azimuth absoluteZoom Notes The device shall not respond with a <ResponseStatus> until the PTZ command has been issued. The total round-trip time for this API should be less than 70 ms. Either the inbound data or query string values are used. All parameters in the <Absolute> block must be provided. The device will pan/tilt to the provided elevation and azimuth degrees in respect to the device''s “home” position. The device will also zoom to the position specified by <absoluteZoom>. The “homePosition” URI should be called first to configure the device''s “home” or “zero” position. The auto patrol feature is stopped if it is running.

Absolute PTZ Data XML Block

<PTZData version=“1.0”> <Absolute> <elevation> <!-- opt, xs:integer, −90..90 --> </elevation> <azimuth> <!-- opt, xs:integer, 0..360 --> </azimuth> <absoluteZoom> <!-- opt, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </absoluteZoom> </Absolute> </PTZData >

5.9.6 /OpenHome/PTZ/channels/<ID>/status

URI /OpenHome/PTZ/channels/ID/status Type Command Function Get current PTZ camera position information. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <PTZStatus> Notes Currently only querying the absolute coordinates, elevation, azimuth and zoom, is supported.

PTZStatus XML Block

<PTZStatus version=“1.0”> <Absolute> <elevation> <!-- opt, xs:integer, −90..90 --> </elevation> <azimuth> <!-- opt, xs:integer, 0..360 --> </azimuth> <absoluteZoom> <!-- opt, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </absoluteZoom> </Absolute> </PTZStatus >

5.10 /OpenHome/Custom/Detection Data Type Details

5.10.1 MotionDetection

/OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection can be used for both Video Motion detection and Passive Infrared Motion detection methods.

5.10.1.1 /OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection/PIR or /OpenHome/CustomMotionDetection/video

URI /OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection/PIR Type Command or /OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection/ video Function Motion detection configuration for all video input channels. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <MotionDetectionList> Notes Either PIR or video analystics based motion detection methods are supported via this data model. If the device supports video motion detection, a motion detection ID will be allocated for each video input channel ID. The motion detection ID must correspond to the video input channel ID. If the device supports PIR motion detection, one or more PIR detection channels can be supported. If no motion detection capability is supported for a requested path (e.g., /video or /PIR), device returns a MotionDetectionList with no elemen.

MotionDetectionList XML Block

<MotionDetectionList version=“1.0”> <MotionDetection/> <!-- opt--> </MotionDetectionList >

5.10.1.2 /OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection/PIR/<ID> or /OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection/video/<ID>

URI /OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection/ Type Command PIR/ID or /OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection/ video/ID Function Motion detection configuration for all video input channels. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <MotionDetection> PUT <MotionDetection> <ResponseStatus> Notes Note that the ID used here MUST correspond to the video input ID or to a non-videochannel-overallping ID that corresponds to a PIR sensor. For video moton based detection, this interface supports both grid-based and region-based motion detection. The actual types supported can be determined by looking at the result of a GET of /OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection/video/ID/capabilities and looking at the options available for the <regionType> field. Grid-based motion detect divides the image into a set of fixed “bins” that delimit the motion detection area boundaries. ROI-based motion detection allows motion areas or regions of interest to be defined based on pixel coordinates. For PIR-based detection, the regionType and RegionCoordinateList elements are optional.

MotionDetection XML Block

<MotionDetection version=“1.0”> <id> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </id> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> <samplingInterval> <!-- opt, xs:integer, number of frames --> </samplingInterval> <startTriggerTime> <!-- opt, xs:integer, milliseconds --> </startTriggerTime> <endTriggerTime> <!-- opt, xs:integer, milliseconds --> </endTriggerTime> <pirValidTime> <!-- opt, xs:integer, milliseconds --> </pirValidTime> <pirMotionTime> <!-- opt, xs:integer, milliseconds --> </pirMotionTime> <directionSensitivity> <!-- opt, xs:string, “left-right,right-left,up-down,down-up” --> </directionSensitivity> <regionType> <!-- opt, xs:string, “grid,roi” --> </regionType> <minObjectSize><!-- opt, xs:integer, min number of pixels per object --> </minObjectSize> <maxObjectSize><!-- opt, xs:integer, max number of pixels per object --> </maxObjectSize> <Grid> <!-- dep, required if <motionType> is “grid” --> <rowGranularity> <!-- req, xs:integer --> </rowGranularity> <columnGranularity> <!-- req, xs:integer --> </columnGranularity> </Grid> <ROI> <!-- dep, required if <motionType> is “roi” --> <minHorizontalResolution> <!-- req, xs:integer --> </minHorizontalResolution> <minVerticalResolution> <!-- req, xs:integer --> </minVerticalResolution> </ROI> </MotionDetection>

5.10.1.3 /OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection/video/<ID>/capabilities

URI /OpenHome/Custom/MotionDetection/ Type Command video/ID/capabilities Function Motion detection configuration for all video input channels. Query Methods String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <MotionDetectionCapabilities> Notes

MotionDetectionCapabilities XML Block

<MotionDetectionCapabilities version=“1.0”> <samplingInterval min=”0” max=30”><!-- opt, xs:integer, number of frames -- ></samplingInterval> <directionSensitivity opt=”left-right,right-left,up-down,down-up“−> <!-- opt, xs:string--> </directionSensitivity> <regionType opt=”grid,roi”><!-- opt, xs:string --></regionType> </MotionDetectionCapabilities >

5.10.2 SoundDetection

5.10.2.1 /OpenHome/Custom/SoundDetection

URI /OpenHome/Custom/SoundDetection Type Command Function Detection configuration for sound detection channels Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <SoundDetectionList> Notes If the device supports sound detection, a sound detection ID will be allocated for each audio input channel ID. The sound detection ID must correspond to the audio input channel ID.

SoundDetectionList XML Block

<SoundDetectionList version=“1.0”> <SoundDetection/> <!-- opt --> </SoundDetectionList >

5.10.2.2 /OpenHome/Custom/SoundDetection/<ID>

URI /OpenHome/Custom/SouondDetection/ID Type Command Function Sound detection configuration for all audio input channels. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <SoundDetection> PUT <SoundDetection> <ResponseStatus> Notes Note that the ID used here MUST correspond to the audio input channel ID. <triggeringType> indicates the signal conditions to trigger the input port. Rising/Fallin refer to a rising/falling edge of a signal. High/Low will continuously trigger for the duration of the high/low input signal.

SoundDetection XML Block

<SoundDetection version=“1.0”> <id> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </id> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> <triggeringType> <!-- req, xs:string, “high,low,rising,falling” --> </triggeringType> <detectionThreshold> <!-- req, xs:integer, 0..100, percentage--> </detectionThreshold> </SoundDetection>

5.10.3 TemperatureDetection

5.10.3.1 /OpenHome/Custom/TemperatureDetection

URI /OpenHome/Custom/TemperatureDetection Type Command Function Detection configuration for temperature change detection channels Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <TemperatureDetectionList> Notes If the device supports PIR detection, a temperature detection ID will be allocated for each temperature input channel ID. The temperature detection ID must correspond to the temperature input channel ID.

TemperatureDetectionList XML Block

<TemperatureDetectionList version=“1.0”> <TemperatureDetection/> <!-- opt --> </TemperatureDetectionList >

5.10.3.2 /OpenHome/Custom/TemperatureDetection/<ID>

URI /OpenHome/Custom/TemperatureDetection/ID Type Command Function Temperature detection configuration for temperature input channels. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <TemperatureDetection> PUT <TemperatureDetection> <ResponseStatus> Notes Note that the ID used here MUST correspond to the temperature input channel ID. <triggeringType> indicates the signal conditions to trigger the input port. Rising/Fallin refer to a rising/falling edge of a signal. High/Low will continuously trigger for the duration of the high/low input signal.

TemperatureDetection XML Block

<TemperatureDetection version=“1.0”> <id> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </id> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:boolean --> </enabled> <triggeringType> <!-- req, xs:string, “high,low,rising,falling” --> </triggeringType> <detectionThreshold> <!-- req, xs:integer, 0..100, percentage--> </detectionThreshold> </TemperatureDetection>

5.10.3.3 /OpenHome/Custom/TemperatureDetection/<ID>/Current

URI /OpenHome/Custom/TemperatureDetection/ID/Current Type Command Function Get Current Temperature Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <CurrentTemperature> Notes Note that the ID used here MUST correspond to the temperature input ID. Rea-only

CurrentTemperature XML Block

<CurrentTemperature version=“1.0”> <datetime><!-- req, xs:datetime --> </ datetime > <scale> <!-- req, xs:string, “C,F” --> </scale> <degree> <!-- req, xs:integer, in degree--> </degree> </CurrentTemperature>

5.11 /OpenHome/Custom/Event Data Type Details

5.11.1 /OpenHome/Custom/Event

URI /OpenHome/Custom/Event Type Command Function Access and configure the device event behavior and notifications. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <EventNotification> PUT <EventNotification> <ResponseStatus> Notes The event trigger list defines the set of device behaviors that trigger events. The event schedule defines when event notifications are active. The event notification methods define what types of notification (HTTP, XMPP, FTP, e-mail) are supported.

EventNotification XML Block

<EventNotification version=“1.0”> <EventTriggerList/> <!-- opt --> <EventNotificationMethod/> <!-- opt --> </EventNotification >

5.11.2 /OpenHome/Custom/Event/triggers

URI /OpenHome/Custom/Event/triggers Type Command Function Access and configure the device event behavior and notifications. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <EventTriggerList> PUT <EventTriggerList> <ResponseStatus> POST <EventTrigger> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes Event triggering defines how the device reacts to particular events, such as video loss or motion detection.

EventTriggerList XML Block

<EventTriggerList version=“1.0”> <EventTrigger/> <!-- opt --> </EventTriggerList >

5.11.3 /OpenHome/Custom/Event/triggers/<ID>

URI /OpenHome/Custom/Event/triggers/ID Type Command Function Access a particular event trigger. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <EventTrigger> PUT <EventTrigger> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes An event trigger determines how the device reacts when a particular event is detected. The following types are supported: PirMD: trigger on PIR motion detection VMD: trigger on video motion detection. SndD: trigger on sound detection TempD: trigger on temperature detection eventTypeInputID: ID of eventTypeInput. For example, if VMD supports multiple input channels, this Id is used to differentiate between them. For intervalBetweenEvents: minimum interval in seconds between 2 detection triggers

EventTrigger XML Block

<EventTrigger version=“1.0”> <id> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </id> <eventType> <!-- req -->  <!-- req, xs:string, “PirMD, VMD,SndD,TempD”--> </eventType> <eventTypeInputID> <!-- opt, xs:string;id --> </eventTypeInputID > <eventDescription> <!-- opt, xs: string --> </eventDescription> <intervalBetweenEvents> <!-- req, xs:integer, seconds --> </intervalBetweenEvents> <EventTriggerNotificationList/> <!-- opt --> </EventTrigger >

5.11.4 /OpenHome/Custom/Event/triggers/<ID>/notifications

URI /OpenHome/Custom/Event/triggers/ID/notifications Type Command Function List of notification methods and behaviors. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <EventTriggerNotificationList> PUT <EventTriggerNotificationList> <ResponseStatus> POST <EventTriggerNotification> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes This section determines the kinds of notifications that are supported for a particular event trigger and their recurrences and behaviors.

EventTriggerNotificationList XML Block

<EventTriggerNotificationList version=“1.0”> <EventTriggerNotification/> <!-- opt --> </EventTriggerNotificationList >

5.11.5 /OpenHome/Custom/Event/triggers/<ID>/notifications/<NOTIFYID>

URI /OpenHome/Custom/Event/triggers/ID/notifications/ID Type Command Function Access and configure a particular notification trigger. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <EventTriggerNotification> PUT <EventTriggerNotification> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes notificationRecurrence: beginning - send EventAlert at beginning of trigger event beginningandend - send EventAlert at beginning of event detection and at the end recurring - send EventAlert at beginning, continue sending <notificationInterval> while trigger is active until end of detection (e.g. motion stopped). At end of detection, send EventAlert. notificationInterval: interval between EventAlert message is sent while detected event is active

EventTriggerNotification XML Block

<EventTriggerNotification version=“1.0”> <notificationID> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </notificationID> <notificationMethod><!-- req, xs:string, “HTTP,XMPP” --> </notificationMethod> <notificationRecurrence> <!-- req, xs:string, “beginning.beginningandend,recurring” --> </notificationRecurrence> <notificationInterval> <!-- dep, xs:integer, seconds --> </notificationInterval> </EventTriggerNotification >

5.11.6 /OpenHome/Custom/Event/notificationMethods

URI /OpenHome/Custom/Event/notificationMethods Type Command Function Configure notifications. This data type defines how notification should be sent to the Gateway when an event is triggered. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <EventNotificationMethods> PUT <EventNotificationMethods> <ResponseStatus> Notes The following notification types are supported: HTTPS: the device connects to a given address and port and issues an HTTPS POST with the given parameters. <MediaFormat> determines the type of snapshot, video clip and the video clip pre and post recording times. <NonMediaEvent> instructs Camera to post <EventAlert> upon trigger without media upload. For most applications, either <NonMediaEvent> or <MediaFormat> is used, but not both at the same time.

EventNotificationMethods XML Block

<EventNotificationMethods version=“1.0”> <NotificatonList/> <!-- opt --> <MediaFormat> <!-- opt --> <snapShotImageType> <!-- opt, xs:string, “JPEG” --> </snapShotImageType> <videoClipFormatType> <!-- opt, xs:string, ″ASF,MP4,3GP,264″ --></videoClipFormatType> <preCaptureLength> <!-- opt, xs:integer, milliseconds --> </preCaptureLength> <postCaptureLength> <!-- opt, xs:integer, milliseconds --> </postCaptureLength> </MediaFormat> <NonMediaEvent> <!-- opt --> <enabled> <!-- req, xs:string, “yes, no” --> </enabled> <NonMediaEvent> </EventNotificationMethods >

5.11.7 /OpenHome/Custom/Event/notification/Host

URI /OpenHome/Custom/Event/notification/Host Type Command Function Access the list of HTTP notification hosts. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <HostNotificationList> PUT <HostNotificationList> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes Host notification involves the device connecting to a particular URL and delivering an HTTP/XMPP message whenever the event triggers.

HostNotificationList XML Block

<HostNotificationList version=“1.0”> <HostNotification> <!-- opt --></HostNotification > </HostNotificationList >

5.11.8 /OpenHome/Custom/Event/notification/Host/<ID>

URI /OpenHome/Custom/Event/notification/Host/<ID> Type Command Function Access a particular notification host. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <HostNotification> PUT <HostNotification> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes Procedures for how to upload media to Gateway are defined in Section 4.3. This data model only defines the host info for where to upload media. No <username> and <password> elements will be configured since authorization format is defined in Section 4.3.

HostNotification XML Block

<HostNotification version=“1.0”> <id> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </id> <url><!-- req, xs:string --> </url> <httpAuthenticationMethod><!-- opt, xs:string, “MD5digest,BASIC,none” --> </HostNotification >

5.11.9 Notification: EventAlert

The EventAlert Notification is sent when an Event trigger occurs and the Event is configured to send EventAlert (see Section 5.11.6). This data type supports non-media upload alerts, for media upload format, see Section 4.3 Interface Type 3—Media Upload Channels.

URI http or Type Notification https://<ipAddess>:<portNo>/<eventAlertURL> or xmpp://<ip Addess>:<portNo>/<eventAlertURL> or poll://<eventAlertURL> Function This function is used by the Camera to send event alerts to the Gateway. Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result POST EventAlert Notes <eventAlertURL> is derived from <HostNotification> element of /OpenHome/Custom/Event/notification. Response to POST consists of standard HTTP responses (e.g., 200, 404, etc.)

EventAlert XML Block

<EventAlert version=“1.0”> <id> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </id> <dateTime> <!-- req, xs:datetime --> </dateTime> <activePostCount> <!-- req, xs:integer --> </activePostCount> <eventType> <!-- req, xs:string, “PirMD,VMD,SndD,TempD”--> </eventType> <eventState> <!-- req, xs:string, “active,inactive” --> </eventState> <eventDescription> <!-- opt, xs:string --> </eventDescription> <DetectionRegionList> <!-- dep, if <eventType> is “vmd” --> <DetectionRegionEntry> <!-- req -->  <regionID> <!-- req, xs:string;id --> </regionID>  <sensitivityLevel> <!-- req, xs:integer, 0..100 --> </sensitivityLevel>  <detectionThreshold> <!-- req, xs:integer, 0..100 -->  </detectionThreshold> </DetectionRegionEntry>  </DetectionRegionList> </EventAlert >

5.11.10 Examples

Configuration for Motion Detection Alert

The example below illustrates a Command from Gateway to configure the camera to send PIR motion event Notifications to Gateway.

Gateway−>Camera PUT /Custom/Event HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT Camera−>Gateway HTTP/1.1 401 Unauthorized Host: 192.168.1.50 Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:60 GMT WWW-Authenticate: <challenge> Gateway−>Camera PUT /Custom/Event HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 Pragma: no-cache Authorization: Digest <challenge response> Cache-Control: no-cache Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT Content-Type: application/xml; charset=“UTF-8” Content-Length: <size of the xml body below in bytes> <EventNotification> <EventTriggerList> <EventTrigger> <id>0</id> <eventType>PirMD</eventType> <eventTypeInputID>0</eventTypeInputID> <intervalBetweenEvents>300</intervalBetweenEvents> <EventTriggerNotificationList> <EventTriggerNotification> <notificationID>0</notificationID> <notificationMethod>HTTP</notificationMethod> <notificationRecurrence>beginningandend</notificationRecurrence> </EventTriggerNotification> </EventTriggerNotificationList> </EventTrigger> </EventTriggerList> <EventNotificationMethods> <HostNotificationList> <HostNotification> <id>0</id> <url>https://192.168.2.89/service/eventalert/</url> <httpAuthenticationMethod>MD5digest</httpAuthenticationMethod> </HostNotification> </HostNotificationList> <NonMediaEvent> <enabled>true</enabled> </NonMediaEvent> </EventNotificationMethods> </EventNotification>

Motion EventAlert Example

The example below illustrates a Notification from Camera to Gateway when a motion event is detected.

  Camera−>Gateway POST /service/eventalert HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT Gateway−>Camera HTTP/1.1 401 Unauthorized Host: 192.168.1.50 Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:60 GMT WWW-Authenticate: <challenge> Camera−>Gateway POST /service/eventalert HTTP/1.1 Host: 192.168.2.52 Pragma: no-cache Authorization: Digest <challenge response> Cache-Control: no-cache Date: Sat, 11 Jun 2011 18:23:51 GMT Content-Type: application/xml; charset=“UTF-8” Content-Length: <size of the xml body below in bytes> <EventAlert> <id>100</id> <dateTime>2012-01-09T09:01:29.970-08:00</dateTime> <activePostCount>0</activePostCount> <eventType>PirMD</eventType> <eventState>active</eventState> </EventAlert> Gateway −>Camera (response) HTTP/1.1 200 OK

6 Digital Video Recorder Features

OpenHome Content Management can be used to control a Camera's DVR (Digital Video Recorder) features. Functionalities such as local recording (scheduled or manual), searching, and playback of stored video “tracks” from the Camera can be accomplished via data types described here. Data types in this Section follow closely the PSIA Recording and Content Management Device Specification Version 1.1a, or RaCM Specification Version 1.1a. This document enumerates and clarifies the subset of the RaCM Specification used in OpenHome.

6.1 Service Discovery of Camera Content Management Resources

6.1.1 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/api

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/api Type Command Function Retrieve URIs for accessing resources on this device Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET See Service Discovery of Camera Resources section Notes Service discovery of /OpenHome/ContentMgmt Data Type resources and their URLs can be achieved by accessing this URI. See Service Discovery of Camera Resources for detailed response syntax.

6.1.2 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/profile

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/profile Type Command Function Access a Camera's RaCM profile and level of service Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <CMProfile> Notes See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <CMProfile>.

6.2 Storage Configuration Control

Local storage on the Camera can be managed in accordance to resources below:

6.2.1 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/record/storageMounts

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/record/ Type Command storageMounts Function Configure the total local storage available for archiving data Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <MountList> PUT <MountList> <ResponseStatus> POST <Mount> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Note This resource is used to manage the total storage allocation and logical mounts of the Recorder. It is allowable to DELETE the entire list. See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <Mount>, <MountList>

6.2.2 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/record/storageMounts/<id>

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/record/ Type Command storageMounts/id Function Configure local storage for a single <Mount> entry Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <Mount> PUT <Mount> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes POST (i.e. Create) is not allowed for individual <Mount> entry, with given explicit <id>. See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <Mount>

6.3 Recording Session Configuration

A Camera may record/store one or more recording sessions, or “tracks”, in its local storage. “Tracks” are virtual containers. They may, or may not, correspond to a file, or set of files, etc. Basically, a “track” is a handle to specific type of multimedia information (e.g. video or audio) from a specific source. A “track” may contain parameters such as track id, recording method, track size, recording source description, codec type/bitrate/resolution, content type, custom extensions, etc. Furthermore, a track may contain a “schedule” that instructs a Camera to record at predetermined intervals. “Tracks” are managed via resources below:

6.3.1 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/record/profile

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/ Type Command record/profile Function Retrieve track types supported by the Camera Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <CMRecordProfile> Notes For this version of the Specification, only the “standard” track profile is supported. “Polymorphic” and “polytemporal” track profiles may be supported in future versions of this Specification. See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <CMRecordProfile>

6.3.2 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/record/tracks

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/ Type Command record/tracks Function Create/update/delete one or more recording tracks Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <TrackList> PUT <TrackList> <ResponseStatus> POST <Track> <ResponseStatus> Notes This resource is used to manage one or more recording “tracks”. DELETE is not permitted. See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <TrackList>, <Track>

6.3.3 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/record/tracks/<id>

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/ Type Command record/tracks/id Function Manage a particular recording track Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <Track> PUT <Track> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes This resource is used to manage a particular recording “track”. See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <Track>. See RaCM Specification v1.1a for example track creation message exchange, including an example to create a track using scheduled recording.

6.4 Recording Session Control

Instead of using scheduled recording, a “track” (recording session) can also be controlled explicitly via external stimulus via the following resources:

6.4.1 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/record/control/manual/start/tracks/<id>

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/ Type Command record/control/manual/start/ tracks/<id> Function Explicitly start a recording track Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <ResourceDescription> PUT NONE <ResponseStatus> Notes This resource is used to explicitly (or manually) start a recording track, regardless of recording mode. See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <ResourceDescription>

6.4.2 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/record/control/manual/stop/tracks/<id>

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/record/ Type Command control/manual/stop/tracks/<id> Function Explicitly stop a recording track Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <ResourceDescription> PUT NONE <ResponseStatus> Notes This resource is used to explicitly (or manually) stop a recording track, regardless of recording mode. See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <ResourceDescription>

6.4.3 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/record/control/locks

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/record/ Type Command control/locks Function Manage recording locks Query Methods String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <RecordingLockList> PUT <RecordingLockList> <ResponseStatus> POST <RecordingLock> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes This resource is used to manage the list of recording locks See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <RecordingLockList> and <RecordingLock>

6.4.4 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/record/control/locks/<id>

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/record/ Type Command control/locks/<id> Function Manage a specific recording lock Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <RecordingLock> PUT <RecordingLock> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes This resource is used to manage the list of recording locks See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <RecordingLockList> and <RecordingLock>

6.5 Recording Schedules

Recording schedules can either be embedded within each track's configuration or can be configured for a Camera device. Recording schedules for a Camera can be managed using resources below:

6.5.1 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/schedules

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/ Type Command schedules Function Configure a Camera's recording schedule list Query Methods String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET None <ScheduleBlockList> PUT <ScheduleBlockList> <ResponseStatus> POST <ScheduleBlock> <ResponseStatus> Notes Unlike Target assigned <id>'s (e.g. <Track> id's), the ScheduleBlockGUID's are assigned by the external Client. However, it is expected that, for an individual <ScheduleBlock> POSTed during Creation, a successful operation will cause the returned <ResponseStatus> to contain a matching copy of the POSTed <ScheduleBlockGUID> value within the <ID> tag. See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed descriptions of <ScheduleBlock>, <ScheduleBlockList>

6.5.2 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/schedules/<ScheduleBlockGUID>

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/ Type Command schedules/<ScheduleBlockGUID> Function Configure a particular recording schedule from a Camera's recording schedule list Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET None <ScheduleBlock> PUT <ScheduleBlock> <ResponseStatus> DELETE <ResponseStatus> Notes See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <ScheduleBlock>

6.6 Search for Recorded Tracks

Recorded tracks can be “searched” using resources described below:

6.6.1 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/search/description

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/ Type Command serach/descripton Function Retrieve description of REST method parameters and formats available for “search” Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET None <ResourceDescription> Notes See RaCM Specification v1.1a and PSIA Service Model specification Section 7.6 for detailed description of <ResourceDescription>

6.6.2 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/search/profile

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/ Type Command serach/profile Function Retrieve profile/level of the Camera as applied to the “search” functionality Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET None <CMSearchProfile> Notes See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <CMSearchProfile>

6.6.3 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/search

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/ Type Command schedules Function Search recorded “tracks” using supplied search criteria Query Methods String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET <CMSearchDescription> <CMSearchResult or ResponseStatus w/error code> POST <CMSearchDescription> <CMSearchResult or ResponseStatus w/error code> Notes The ‘GET’ or ‘POST’ messages require a “CMSearchDescription” XML document to engage a search. See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed descriptions and examples of <CMSearchDescription> and <CMSearchResult>

6.7 Status

6.7.1 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/status/volume

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/status/ Type Command volumes or/OpenHome/ ContentMgmt/status/volumes/<n> Function Retrieve status of one or more mounted “volumes” within a Camera Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET None <CMStatusVolume> Notes For each Camera, there is at least one mounted “volume” that provides logical storage for recorded tracks. GET to . . . /volumes will return status for ALL volumes. GET to . . . /volumes/<n> will return status for a particular volume. See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <CMStatusVolume>.

6.7.2 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/status/sources

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/ Type Command status/sources or /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/ status/sources/<GUID> Function Retrieve status of one or more input “source” Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET None <CMSourceStatus> Notes Each channel and track within a RaCM device's content base is correlated to a ‘source.’ A source is the input device that originated the multimedia content managed by the RaCM device. For each source, the RaCM content manager maintains a set of status attributes. These status attributes relate to the source itself, the channels that source is inputting, and the track(s) that correspond to that source. For the current Specification, each Camera only needs to support ONE source with a unique GUID. See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <CMSourceStatus>.

6.7.3 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/status/channels

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/ Type Command status/channels or /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/ status/channels/<ID> Function Retrieve status of one or more input “channels” Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET None <CMChannelStatus> Notes A “channel” is a specific instance of an input data stream (e.g., video input source). The available channel <ID> must match channel <ID> used in /OpenHome/Streaming/Channels. See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <CMChannelStatus>.

6.7.4 /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/status/tracks

URI /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/ Type Command status/tracks or /OpenHome/ContentMgmt/ status/tracks/<id> Function Retrieve status of one or more input “tracks” Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET None <CMTrackStatus> Notes See RaCM Specification v1.1a for detailed description of <CMTrackStatus>.

6.8 Streaming Playback and Archived Media Upload

Archived recordings are organized into “tracks”, each with unique IDs. One or more “tracks” can be streamed to Gateway/end-user or be uploaded to the Gateway via accessing resources below. Please note these resources are not intended for live video viewing; for live video, refer to /OpenHome/Streaming/Channels/ . . .

6.8.1.1 /OpenHome/Streaming/tracks/<ID>/http

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/tracks/ID/http Type Command Function Request streaming of MJPEG video from one or more tracks Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result RTSP track=<trackID> Stream over RTSP starttime=<start time> endtime=<end time> Notes One or more optional “track” query parameters can be added to the URI. The additional “tracks” are to be streamed sequentially, one after another. Example: rtsp://<ip:port>/OpenHome/Streaming/tracks/10/http?track=12&track=22&track =100 The above example will stream MJPEG video for tracks 10, 12, 22, and 100 sequentially. Starttime and endtime are in ISO 8601 timestamp (RFC 2326). When multiple tracks are identified in a single URI, they can only share one time range. This resource may be accessed from within a Media Tunnel (see RTSP Media Tunneling).

6.8.1.2 /OpenHome/Streaming/tracks/<ID>/rtsp

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/tracks/ID/rtsp Type Command Function Request streaming of video from one or more tracks Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result RTSP track=<trackID> Stream over RTSP starttime=<start time> endtime=<end time> Notes One or more optional “track” query parameters can be added to the URI. The additional “tracks” are to be streamed sequentially, one after another. Example: rtsp://<ip:port>/OpenHome/Streaming/tracks/10/rtsp?track=12&track=22&track =100 The above example will stream via RTSP tracks 10, 12, 22, and 100 sequentially. Starttime and endtime are in ISO 8601 timestamp (RFC 2326). When multiple tracks are identified in a single URI, they can only share one time range. This resource may be accessed from within a Media Tunnel (see RTSP Media Tunneling).

6.8.1.3 /OpenHome/Streaming/tracks/<ID>/hls/playlist

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/tracks/ID/ Type Command hls/playlist Function Retrieve HLS Playlist file for one or more archived tracks Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET track=<trackID> HTTP Live starttime=<start time> Streaming Playlist endtime=<end time> file Notes One or more optional “track” query parameters can be added to the URI. The additional “tracks” are to be streamed sequentially, one after another. Starttime and endtime are in ISO 8601 timestamp (RFC 2326). When multiple tracks are identified in a single URI, they can only share one time range. This resource may be accessed from within a Media Tunnel (see HLS Media Tunneling). See /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/hls/playlist for recommendations/restrictions on HLS playlist.

6.8.1.4 /OpenHome/Streaming/tracks/<ID>/hls/<MediaSegment>

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/ Type Command ID/hls/playlist/MediaSegment Function Retrieve HTTP Live Streaming media segment Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result GET HTTP Live Streaming media segment Notes This is the recommended (but not mandatory) HTTP Live Streaming media segment URI format. The actual URI is specified in the HLS Playlist file (see /OpenHome/Streaming/tracks/<ID>/hls/playlist). HTTP Basic Authentication is used to authenticate access. For on-premise viewing, HTTP or HTTPS can be used. For off-premise viewing, media must be protected via SSL using the HLS Media Tunnel procedures.

6.8.1.5 /OpenHome/Streaming/tracks/<ID>/video/upload

URI /OpenHome/Streaming/tracks/ID/video/ Type Command upload Function This function is used to trigger an upload of one or more tracks to the Gateway Methods Query String(s) Inbound Data Return Result POST track=<trackID> <MediaUpload> <ResponseStatus> starttime=<start time> endtime=<end time> Notes Only the <id>, <gatewayURL>, and <failureURL> parameters within <MediaUpload> are valid for this use case. See /OpenHome/Streaming/channels/<ID>/video/upload for definition of <MediaUpload> and Media Upload Channels for media upload procedures.

Appendix A—Local Bootstrap Procedures

Local Bootstrap Procedures consist of 1) Camera discovery and 2) Camera configuration. Each step is described in more detail below:

Step 1—Camera Discovery

Camera discovery is achieved using UPnP's SSDP (Simple Service Discovery Protocol) process, where the Premise Gateway searches for one or more Cameras using the Camera's pre-configured USN (Unique Service Name). Camera must be pre-configured with a USN specified by iControl. Please refer to the UPnP specification (www.upnp.org) for a definition of the UPnP discovery procedure.

Step 2—Camera Configuration

If a Camera is discoverable via Step 1, and end-user/installer confirms intention to activate a specific Camera, the Premise Gateway will issue the following Commands via the HTTP/HTTPS Command Channel (see Section 4.1.2.1) to configure the Camera:

-   -   1. GET /<ipAddress>/index/—and walk index tree to discover API         resource availability and URI     -   2. GET /<ipAddress>/System/deviceInfo (or the equivalent URI)—to         determine device model, version, etc.     -   3. If firmware upgrade is required:         -   a. POST /<ipAddress>/System/updateFirmware         -   b. Wait for upgrade to finish (including wait for reboot)         -   c. GET /<ipAddress>/System/deviceInfo—retrieve deviceInfo             again     -   4. PUT /<ipAddress>/System/ConfigurationData/configFile—upload a         complete configuration file to Camera based on <deviceInfo>         data.     -   5. If reboot required, /PUT/<ipAddress>:<port>/System/reboot     -   6. (Optional) POST         /<ipAddress>:<port>/Security/updateSSLCertificate/server—this         additional Command may be issued if server certificate is to be         used.

<ipAddress> is the Camera IP address discovered in Step 1. All Commands above require administrative account privileges, therefore, the pre-configured administration account should be used to issue the above Commands.

Appendix B—Off-Premise Bootstrap Procedures

The Off-Premise Bootstrap procedures are used by the Camera to retrieve its siteID, shared secret, and remote Gateway addresses. FIG. 30 illustrates steps involved.

Using Step 1, Camera connects to the Registry Gateway (via the pre-configured Registry Gateway URL) and retrieves its assigned siteID and the Credential Gateway URL. Next, via Step 2, Camera retrieves its shared secret from the Credential Gateway using its siteID and Activation Key. Lastly, via Step 3, Camera retrieves Session Gateway Information from the Credential Gateway. At the end of the Bootstrap phase, the Camera will have obtained its secret credentials and its Session Gateway address from the iControl Gateway. Each of the Steps is describe in more detail below.

Bootstrap Procedure Frequency

Camera should perform bootstrap procedures upon EVERY device reboot. Upon startup, If SharedSecret is not set (e.g., brand new Camera, post factory reset), Camera should perform bootstrap Steps 1-3. Upon startup, if SharedSecret is already established (see Step 2), Camera should perform bootstrap Steps 1 and 3 only, and skip Step 2.

Step 1—Retrieve Gateway URL and SiteID

This procedure step is used by the Camera to retrieve its SiteID and Credential Gateway URL.

TABLE 14 Retrieve Gateway URI and SiteID format Purpose Retrieve Credential Gateway URL and camera siteID using camera Serial Number as input Message HTTPS GET /<Registry Gateway URL>/<Serial Number> HTTP/1.1 Format Authentication None Mandatory Host Request Headers 200 OK <registryEntry serial=“<Serial Number>” href=“/<Registry Gateway response URL>/<Serial Number>”>   <functions>...</functions >   <siteId><siteID></siteId>   <gatewayUrl><Credential Gateway URL></gatewayUrl> </registryEntry> Error Standard HTTP response codes (e.g., 404) responses Example https://adminsirius3.icontrol.com/rest/icontrol/registry/serial/00603504026c Request Example 200 <registryEntry serial=“00:60:35:04:02:6c” OK Response href=“/rest/icontrol/registry/serial/00603504026c”>   <functions count=“1”>     <function name=“delete”     action=“/rest/icontrol/registry/serial/00603504026c”     method=“DELETE”/>   </functions>   <siteId>00603504026c</siteId>   <gatewayUrl>http://gsess-   sirius3.icontrol.com/gw</gatewayUrl> </registryEntry>

TABLE 15 Retrieve Gateway URI and SiteID Variables Variable Name Format Description/Notes Registry Gateway URL URL Pre-configured in camera Serial Number 12 byte hex string Pre-configured in camera siteID 12-20 digit alpha numeric string gatewayUrl otherwise URL prefix Prefix to use for Pending known as protocol:host[:port]/ Secret and Connect Info CredentialGatewayURL path requests.

Step 2—Retrieve Credential

This procedure step is used by the Camera to retrieve its Pending Key. If SharedSecret is already established from previous successful Retrieve Credital procedure, this step should be skipped.

TABLE 16 Retrieve Credential Message Format Purpose Retrieve camera specific shared secret using camera siteID, camera serial and Activation Key as inputs Message HTTPS POST/< Format CredentialGatewayURL>/GatewayService/<siteID>/PendingDeviceKey HTTP/1.1 Authentication None Mandatory Host, Content-Length, Content-Type (application/x-www-form- Request urlencoded) Headers POST body serial=<Serial Number>&activationkey=<ActivationKey> 200 OK <pendingPaidKey method=“server” expires=“<pending key expiration response with epoch millisecs>” ts=“<current epoch millisecs>” pending key key=“<SharedSecret>” partner=“icontrol”/> 200 OK Gateway responds with a method=”retry” when the camera is not yet response with activated within the system. Response includes timeout for retry. retry <PendingPaidKey method=“retry” expires=“<retry epoch millisecs>” ts=“<current epoch millisecs>” partner=“icontrol”/> Other HTTP Standard HTTP error response codes for example 5xx indicate a responses temporary server issue and cameras should perform an automatic retry in randomized 10 minute backoff. Example serial-555500000010&activationkey=AABB12345678 POST body Example 200 <pendingPaidKey method=“server” expires=“1308892493528” OK with ts=“1308849293540” key=“398341159498190458” pending key partner=“icontrol”/> Response Example 200 <pendingPaidKey method=“retry” expires=“1308849242148” OK response ts=“1308849122148” partner=“icontrol”/> with retry

TABLE 17 Retrieve Credential Variables Variable Name Format Description/Notes CredentialGatewayURL Hostname[:port] Retrieved via Step 1- Retrieve Gateway URL and SiteID PendingSecretPath URL path Retrieved via Step 1- Retrieve Gateway URL and SiteID siteID 12 byte hexadecimal string Retrieved via Step 1- Retrieve Gateway URL and SiteID ActivationKey 10+ digit alpha numeric Pre-configured in camera string ‘method’ (in 200 OK body) String “server” or “retry” ‘key’ (in 200 OK body) Alphanumeric string Pending key returned by Gateway in 200 OK body ‘ts’ (in 200 OK body) Numeric string Gateway's timestamp in UTC time ‘expires’ (in 200 OK body) Numeric string UTC time when the current pending key expires Pending Key Alphanumeric string Initial key retrieved from Gateway that is not yet confirmed with the Gateway. SharedSecret or active key Alphanumeric string Pending key becomes <SharedSecret> after successful connection to Gateway (see below)

Pending Key→SharedSecret Retrieval Process

While Camera activation is underway, the Gateway will respond to a Camera's request for Credential with 200 OK containing the PendingPaidKey XML body (with method=“server”) with a pending key field. The pending key field will become active once the Camera connects to the Gateway over the XMPP channel and is authenticated using the pending key as its password. Once authenticated (via a successful XMPP session with the Gateway), the key is no longer pending and instead becomes active, or otherwise known as the Camera's <SharedSecret>. The active key (a.k.a, <SharedSecret>) will not automatically expire; however, the Gateway may update a Camera's <SharedSecret> using the SetKey command over the XMPP interface. Once a pending key becomes active, subsequent requests for the PendingDeviceKey will receive method=“retry” responses unless a new activation process is initiated (this can be done by administrators and installers via the iControl admin and portal applications).

If the Camera does not connect to the server over the XMPP channel and be authenticated using the key by the “expires” time specified in the PendingPaidKey XML body, then the pending key will expire and no longer be valid.

While Camera activation is underway, each request for the PendingPaidKey will receive a different key in the response, causing the previous pending key to be replaced with the new one.

It is expected that upon a factory reset, the device will forget its key and return to the bootstrap process of polling for a PendingDeviceKey.

Step 3—Retrieve Session Gateway Info

This procedure step is used by the Camera to retrieve Session Gateway Info, which includes XMPP Gateway address.

TABLE 18 Retrieve XMPP Gateway Info Message Format Purpose Retrieve XMPP Gateway hostname and port from Credential Gateway Message HTTPS GET /<gatewayUrl>/GatewayService/<siteID>/ Format connectInfo HTTP/1.1 Authentication None Mandatory Host Request Headers 200 OK <connectInfo> response  <session host=<Session Gateway host> port=[port] />  <xmpp host=<XMPP Gateway host> port=[port] /> </connectInfo> Error Standard HTTP response codes (e.g., 404) responses Example 200 < connectInfo> OK Response  <session host=”server1.icontrol.com” port=“443” />  <xmpp host=”server1.icontrol.com” port=”5222” /> </ connectInfo>

TABLE 19 Retrieve XMPP Gateway Info Variables Variable Name Format Description/Notes gatewayUrl https://hostname[:port]/ Retrieved Via Step 1- path Retrieve Gateway URL and SiteID siteID 12-20 char alpha numeric Retrieved Via Step 1- string Retrieve Gateway URL and SiteID XMPP Gateway Hostname and port Host and port to use for host:port IPAddress and port XMPP communication with the Gateway. Session Gateway Hostname and port This variable should be host:port IPAddress and port ignored by the Camera

Appendix C—Activation Key Derivation Procedures

A Camera's activation key is derived from its serial number and a master secret. An activation key is 20 hex characters (0-f) long.

The first 10 characters of the activation key will be the last 10 characters of the serial number. The first 2 characters of the serial number will be derived from server configuration and will default to “00”.

A manufacturer-specific global code is now introduced which can be customer-specific and must be configured on the server. An example value for this will is “lw2jd3Dq”. This portion will be referred to as “globalCode” below.

The next 8 characters will be the first 8 characters of the MD5 hash of the following concatenation: globalCode+serialNumber.

The last 2 characters will be a CRC checksum of the first 18 in hex. The CRC8 checksum algorithm used should be “CRC-8-Dallas/Maxim x8+x5+x4+1 (1-Wire bus)”.

Examples:

Activation key for 006035010057 will be 6035 0100 57ef 8c2a a6ba

-   -   MD5(lw2jd3Dq006035010057)=ef8c2aa65441ebddd5b7d5351a7e1058     -   CRC(6035010057ef8c2aa6)=0xBA

Activation key for 006035000000 will be 6035 0000 0014 B08F C388

Glossary and Terminologies

-   AAA Authentication, Authorization, and Accounting -   AP Access Point -   BSSID Basic Service Set Identifier -   CA Certificate Authority -   DNS Domain Name System -   GUUID Globally Universally Unique Identifier -   HLS HTTP Live Streaming (Internet     draft-pantos-http-live-streaming-07) -   HTTP/HTTPS Hypertext Transfer Protocol (Secured) -   PIR Passive Infra Red -   PSIA Physical Security Interoperability Alliance     (www.psialliance.org) -   PTZ Pan, Tilt, Zoom -   RaCM PSIA Recording and Content Management (Specification) -   RFC Request for Proposal -   RSSI Received Signal Strength Indication -   RTP Real Time Transport Protocol -   RTSP Real Time Streaming Protocol -   SASL Simple Authorization and Security Layer (part of XMPP) -   SSDP Simple Service Discovery Protocol (used by UPnP) -   SSID Service Set Identifier -   SSL Secure Sockets Layer (predecessor to TLS) -   TCP Transmission Control Protocol -   TLS Transport Layer Security -   URI/URL Universal Resource Identifier/Universal Resource Locator -   UPnP Universal Plug and Play -   USN Unique Service Number (UPnP device specific ID) -   UTC Coordinated Universal Time -   XML Extensible Markup Language -   XMPP Extensible Messaging and Presence Protocol (RFC 6120) 

1. A system comprising: a gateway device, located at a premises, configured to communicate with a plurality of premises devices located at the premises; and a camera device located at the premises and configured to: receive, from a server device associated with the premises, via the gateway device, and based on a first format, authentication information associated with the camera device and a uniform resource locator associated with at least one computing device located external to the premises, and send, to the at least one computing device, via a second format different from the first format and based on the authentication information and the uniform resource locator, content.
 2. The system of claim 1, wherein the first format and the second format comprise different, one or more of: messaging formats, interface formats, or communication protocols.
 3. The system of claim 1, wherein the first format comprises one of a bi-directional asynchronous communications format, a hypertext transfer protocol (HTTP) format, a hypertext transfer protocol secure (HTTPS) format, or an extensible messaging and presence protocol (XMPP) format.
 4. The system of claim 1, wherein the second format comprises one of a streaming media format, a real time streaming protocol (RTSP) format, a motion JPEG (MJPEG) format, a hypertext transfer protocol live streaming format, a media upload format, a video upload format, or an image upload format.
 5. The system of claim 1, wherein the at least one computing device located external to the premises comprises at least one of a server, a session server, a security server, a web server, an application server, a database server, a gateway, a session gateway, a premises monitoring system, or a central monitoring station.
 6. The system of claim 1, wherein the gateway device located at the premises comprises one or more of a radio frequency (RF) gateway, a router, a computing device, or a touchscreen device.
 7. The system of claim 1, wherein the camera device is further configured to send, to the at least one computing device located external to the premises, the content by streaming the content.
 8. A method comprising: receiving, by a camera device located at a premises from a server device associated with the premises, via a gateway device located at the premises, and based on a first format, authentication information associated with the camera device and a uniform resource locator associated with at least one computing device located external to the premises; and sending, by the camera device, to the at least one computing device, via a second format different than the first format and based on the authentication information and the uniform resource locator, content.
 9. The method of claim 8, wherein the first format and the second format comprise different, one or more of: messaging formats, interface formats, or communication protocols.
 10. The method of claim 8, wherein the first format comprises one of a bi-directional asynchronous communications format, a hypertext transfer protocol (HTTP) format, a hypertext transfer protocol secure (HTTPS) format, or an extensible messaging and presence protocol (XMPP) format.
 11. The method of claim 8, wherein the second format comprises one of a streaming media format, a real time streaming protocol (RTSP) format, a motion JPEG (MJPEG) format, a hypertext transfer protocol live streaming format, a media upload format, a video upload format, or an image upload format.
 12. The method of claim 8, wherein the at least one computing device located external to the premises comprises at least one of a server, a session server, a security server, a web server, an application server, a database server, a gateway, a session gateway, a premises monitoring system, or a central monitoring station.
 13. The method of claim 8, wherein the gateway device located at the premises comprises one or more of a radio frequency (RF) gateway, a router, a computing device, or a touchscreen device.
 14. The method of claim 8, wherein sending the content comprises sending the content by streaming the content.
 15. A non-transitory computer-readable storage medium storing instructions that, when executed, cause: receiving, by a camera device located at a premises from a server device associated with the premises, via a gateway device located at the premises, and based on a first format, authentication information associated with the camera device and a uniform resource locator associated with at least one computing device located external to the premises; and sending, by the camera device, to the at least one computing device, via a second format different than the first format and based on the authentication information and the uniform resource locator, content.
 16. The non-transitory computer-readable storage medium of claim 15, wherein the first format and the second format comprise different, one or more of: messaging formats, interface formats, or communication protocols.
 17. The non-transitory computer-readable storage medium of claim 15, wherein the first format comprises one of a bi-directional asynchronous communications format, a hypertext transfer protocol (HTTP) format, a hypertext transfer protocol secure (HTTPS) format, or an extensible messaging and presence protocol (XMPP) format.
 18. The non-transitory computer-readable storage medium of claim 15, wherein the second format comprises one of a streaming media format, a real time streaming protocol (RTSP) format, a motion JPEG (MJPEG) format, a hypertext transfer protocol live streaming format, a media upload format, a video upload format, or an image upload format.
 19. The non-transitory computer-readable storage medium of claim 15, wherein the at least one computing device located external to the premises comprises at least one of a server, a session server, a security server, a web server, an application server, a database server, a gateway, a session gateway, a premises monitoring system, or a central monitoring station.
 20. The non-transitory computer-readable storage medium of claim 15, wherein the gateway device located at the premises comprises one or more of a radio frequency (RF) gateway, a router, a computing device, or a touchscreen device.
 21. The non-transitory computer-readable storage medium of claim 15, wherein sending the content comprises sending the content by streaming the content.
 22. A camera device comprising: one or more processors; and memory storing instructions that, when executed by the one or more processors, cause the device to: receive, at a premises from a server device associated with the premises, via a gateway device located at the premises, and based on a first format, authentication information associated with the camera device and a uniform resource locator associated with at least one computing device located external to the premises; and send to the at least one computing device, via a second format different than the first format and based on the authentication information and the uniform resource locator, content.
 23. The device of claim 22, wherein the first format and the second format comprise different, one or more of: messaging formats, interface formats, or communication protocols.
 24. The device of claim 22, wherein the first format comprises one of a bi-directional asynchronous communications format, a hypertext transfer protocol (HTTP) format, a hypertext transfer protocol secure (HTTPS) format, or an extensible messaging and presence protocol (XMPP) format.
 25. The device of claim 22, wherein the second format comprises one of a streaming media format, a real time streaming protocol (RTSP) format, a motion JPEG (MJPEG) format, a hypertext transfer protocol live streaming format, a media upload format, a video upload format, or an image upload format.
 26. The device of claim 22, wherein the at least one computing device located external to the premises comprises at least one of a server, a session server, a security server, a web server, an application server, a database server, a gateway, a session gateway, a premises monitoring system, or a central monitoring station.
 27. The device of claim 22, wherein the gateway device located at the premises comprises one or more of a radio frequency (RF) gateway, a router, a computing device, or a touchscreen device.
 28. The device of claim 22, wherein the instructions that, when executed by the one or more processors, cause the device to send the content comprises instructions that, when executed by the one or more processors, cause the device to send the content by streaming the content. 